]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
1b746f87d53a0dff48f620e8d1c32b9406ddb39e
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #include <unistd.h>
89
90 #ifdef USE_GTK
91 #include "gtkutil.h"
92 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
93 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
94 #endif
95 #endif
96
97 #ifdef USE_LUCID
98 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
99 #endif
100
101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
102 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
103 #define HACK_EDITRES
104 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
105 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
106
107 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
108
109 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
110 #if defined USE_MOTIF
111 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
112 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
113 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
114
115 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
116 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
119 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
120 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
122 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
123 #ifndef XtNpickTop
124 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
125 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
126 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
127 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
128
129 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
130
131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
132 #include "widget.h"
133 #ifndef XtNinitialState
134 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
135 #endif
136 #endif
137
138 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
139
140 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
141 #ifdef USE_XIM
142 int use_xim = 1;
143 #else
144 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
145 #endif
146
147 \f
148
149 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
150 start. */
151
152 static int any_help_event_p;
153
154 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
155 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
159
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161
162 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
163 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
164 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
165 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166
167 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168
169 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
170 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
171 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
172 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173
174 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175
176 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177
178 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179
180 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181
182 static struct {
183 struct frame *f;
184 int eventtype;
185 } pending_event_wait;
186
187 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
188 /* The application context for Xt use. */
189 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
190 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
191
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
196
197 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
198 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
199 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200
201 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202
203 /* Mouse movement.
204
205 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
206 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
207 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
208 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209
210 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211
212 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
213 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
214 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
215 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
216 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
217 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
218 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
219 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
220 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
221 is off. */
222
223 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224
225 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
226 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228
229 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230
231 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
232 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
233 an ordinary motion.
234
235 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
236 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
237 event. */
238
239 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240
241 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
242 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
243 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
244 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
245 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
246 it's somewhat accurate. */
247
248 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249
250 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251
252 static Time last_user_time;
253
254 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
255 events. */
256
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258
259 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
260
261 static int x_noop_count;
262
263 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
264
265 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
266 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
267
268 #ifdef USE_GTK
269 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
270 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
271
272 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
273 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
274 #endif
275
276 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
277 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
278
279 enum xembed_info
280 {
281 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
282 };
283
284 enum xembed_message
285 {
286 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
287 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
288 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
289 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
290 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
291 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
292 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
294
295 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
296 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
297 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
298 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
299 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
300 };
301
302 /* Used in x_flush. */
303
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
306 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
307 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
308 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
309 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
310
311 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
312 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
313 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
314 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
315 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
316 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
317 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
319 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
320 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
321 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
322 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
323 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
324 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
325 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
326 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
327 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
329 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
330 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
331 enum text_cursor_kinds);
332
333 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
334 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
335 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
336 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
337 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
338 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
339 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
340 enum scroll_bar_part *,
341 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
342 Time *);
343 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
344 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
345 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
346 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
347 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
348 int *, struct input_event *);
349 #ifdef USE_GTK
350 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
351 #endif
352 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
353 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
354 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
355 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
356 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
357 static void x_initialize (void);
358
359
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
361
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
364 {
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
369
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
372 {
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
377 }
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
381 }
382
383
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
390
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392
393 \f
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
397
398 #if 0
399
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
402
403 struct record
404 {
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
407 };
408
409 struct record event_record[100];
410
411 int event_record_index;
412
413 void
414 record_event (char *locus, int type)
415 {
416 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
417 event_record_index = 0;
418
419 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
420 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
421 event_record_index++;
422 }
423
424 #endif /* 0 */
425
426
427 \f
428 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
429
430 struct x_display_info *
431 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
432 {
433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
434
435 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
436 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
437 return dpyinfo;
438
439 return 0;
440 }
441
442 static Window
443 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
444 {
445 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
446 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
447 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
448
449 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
450 {
451 Window root;
452 Window *children;
453 unsigned int nchildren;
454
455 win = wi;
456 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
457 XFree (children);
458 }
459
460 return win;
461 }
462
463 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
464
465 void
466 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
467 {
468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
469 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
470 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
471 double alpha = 1.0;
472 double alpha_min = 1.0;
473 unsigned long opac;
474 Window parent;
475
476 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
477 alpha = f->alpha[0];
478 else
479 alpha = f->alpha[1];
480
481 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
482 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
483 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
484 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
485
486 if (alpha < 0.0)
487 return;
488 else if (alpha > 1.0)
489 alpha = 1.0;
490 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
491 alpha = alpha_min;
492
493 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
494
495 x_catch_errors (dpy);
496
497 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
498 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
499 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
500 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
501
502 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
503 if (parent != None)
504 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
506 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
507
508 /* return unless necessary */
509 {
510 unsigned char *data;
511 Atom actual;
512 int rc, format;
513 unsigned long n, left;
514
515 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
516 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
517 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
518 &data);
519
520 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
521 {
522 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
523 XFree (data);
524 if (value == opac)
525 {
526 x_uncatch_errors ();
527 return;
528 }
529 }
530 }
531
532 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
533 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
534 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
535 x_uncatch_errors ();
536 }
537
538 int
539 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
540 {
541 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
542 }
543
544 int
545 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
546 {
547 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
548 }
549
550 \f
551 /***********************************************************************
552 Starting and ending an update
553 ***********************************************************************/
554
555 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
556 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
557 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
558 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
559 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
560
561 static void
562 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
563 {
564 /* Nothing to do. */
565 }
566
567
568 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
569 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
570 position of W. */
571
572 static void
573 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
574 {
575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
576 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
577
578 updated_window = w;
579 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
580
581 BLOCK_INPUT;
582
583 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
584 {
585 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
586 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
587
588 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
589 highlighting. */
590 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
591 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
592 }
593
594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
595 }
596
597
598 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
599
600 static void
601 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
602 {
603 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
604 struct face *face;
605
606 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
607 if (face)
608 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
609 face->foreground);
610
611 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
612 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
613 }
614
615 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
616
617 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
618 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
619
620 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
621 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
622 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
623
624 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
625 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
626 here. */
627
628 static void
629 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
630 {
631 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
632
633 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
634 {
635 BLOCK_INPUT;
636
637 if (cursor_on_p)
638 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
639 output_cursor.vpos,
640 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
641
642 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
643 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
644
645 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
646 }
647
648 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
649 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
650 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
651 {
652 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
653 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
654 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
655 }
656
657 updated_window = NULL;
658 }
659
660
661 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
662 update_end. */
663
664 static void
665 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
666 {
667 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
668 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
669
670 #ifndef XFlush
671 BLOCK_INPUT;
672 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
674 #endif
675 }
676
677
678 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
679 complete update has been performed. The global variable
680 updated_window is not available here. */
681
682 static void
683 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
684 {
685 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
686 {
687 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
688
689 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
690 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
691 {
692 BLOCK_INPUT;
693 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
695 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
697 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
699 }
700 }
701 }
702
703
704 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
705 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
706 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
707 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
708 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
709 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
710
711 static void
712 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
713 {
714 struct window *w = updated_window;
715 struct frame *f;
716 int width, height;
717
718 eassert (w);
719
720 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
721 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
722
723 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
724 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
725 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
726 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
727 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
728 overhead is very small. */
729 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
730 && desired_row->full_width_p
731 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
732 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
733 width != 0)
734 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
735 height > 0))
736 {
737 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
738
739 BLOCK_INPUT;
740 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
741 0, y, width, height, False);
742 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
743 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
744 y, width, height, False);
745 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
746 }
747 }
748
749 static void
750 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
751 {
752 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
753 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
754 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
755 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
756 struct face *face = p->face;
757
758 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
759 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
760
761 if (!p->overlay_p)
762 {
763 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
764
765 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
766 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
767 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
768 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
769 if (face->stipple)
770 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
771 else
772 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
773
774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
775 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
776 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
777 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
778 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
779 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
780 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
781 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
782 {
783 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
784
785 if (sb_width > 0)
786 {
787 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
788 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
789 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
790
791 if (bx < 0)
792 {
793 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
794 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
795 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
796 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
797 bx = bar_area_x;
798 if (bx >= 0)
799 {
800 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
801
802 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
804 row->y));
805 ny = row->visible_height;
806 }
807 }
808 else
809 {
810 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
811 {
812 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
813 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
814 }
815 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
817 }
818 }
819 }
820 #endif
821 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
822 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
823
824 if (!face->stipple)
825 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
826 }
827
828 if (p->which)
829 {
830 char *bits;
831 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
832 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
833 XGCValues gcv;
834
835 if (p->wd > 8)
836 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
837 else
838 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
839
840 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
841 by the server. */
842 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
843 (p->cursor_p
844 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
845 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
846 : face->foreground),
847 face->background, depth);
848
849 if (p->overlay_p)
850 {
851 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
852 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
853 bits, p->wd, p->h,
854 1, 0, 1);
855 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
856 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
857 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
858 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
859 }
860
861 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
862 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
863 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
864
865 if (p->overlay_p)
866 {
867 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
868 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
869 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
870 }
871 }
872
873 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
874 }
875
876 \f
877
878 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
879 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
880 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
881 rarely happens). */
882
883 static void
884 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
885 {
886 }
887
888 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
889 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
890
891 static void
892 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
893 {
894 }
895
896 \f
897 /***********************************************************************
898 Glyph display
899 ***********************************************************************/
900
901
902
903 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
904 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
905 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
906 int);
907 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
911 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
912 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
916 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
917 unsigned long *, double, int);
918 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
919 double, int, unsigned long);
920 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
921 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
922 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
923 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
925 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
926 int, int, int);
927 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
928 int, int, int, int, int, int,
929 XRectangle *);
930 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
932 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
933
934 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
935 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
936 #endif
937
938
939 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
940 face. */
941
942 static void
943 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
944 {
945 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
946 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
947 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
948 && !s->cmp)
949 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
950 else
951 {
952 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
953 XGCValues xgcv;
954 unsigned long mask;
955
956 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
957 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
958
959 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
960 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
962 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
963 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966
967 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
968 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
969 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
970 {
971 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
972 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
973 }
974
975 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
976 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
977 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
978
979 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
980 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
981 mask, &xgcv);
982 else
983 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
984 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
985
986 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
987 }
988 }
989
990
991 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
992
993 static void
994 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
995 {
996 int face_id;
997 struct face *face;
998
999 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1000 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1001 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1002 if (face == NULL)
1003 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1004
1005 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1006 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1007 else
1008 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1009 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1010 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1011
1012 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1014 else
1015 {
1016 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1017 except for FONT. */
1018 XGCValues xgcv;
1019 unsigned long mask;
1020
1021 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1024 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1025
1026 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1027 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1028 mask, &xgcv);
1029 else
1030 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1031 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1032
1033 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1034
1035 }
1036 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1037 }
1038
1039
1040 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1041 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1042 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1043
1044 static inline void
1045 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1046 {
1047 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1048 }
1049
1050
1051 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1052 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1053 pattern. */
1054
1055 static inline void
1056 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1057 {
1058 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1059
1060 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1061 {
1062 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1063 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 }
1065 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1066 {
1067 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1068 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1069 }
1070 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1071 {
1072 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1073 s->stippled_p = 0;
1074 }
1075 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1076 {
1077 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1078 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1079 }
1080 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1081 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1082 {
1083 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1085 }
1086 else
1087 {
1088 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1090 }
1091
1092 /* GC must have been set. */
1093 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1094 }
1095
1096
1097 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1098 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1099
1100 static inline void
1101 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1102 {
1103 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1104 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1105
1106 if (n > 0)
1107 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1108 s->num_clips = n;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1113 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1114 the area of SRC. */
1115
1116 static void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1118 {
1119 XRectangle r;
1120
1121 r.x = src->x;
1122 r.width = src->width;
1123 r.y = src->y;
1124 r.height = src->height;
1125 dst->clip[0] = r;
1126 dst->num_clips = 1;
1127 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1128 }
1129
1130
1131 /* RIF:
1132 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1133
1134 static void
1135 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1136 {
1137 if (s->cmp == NULL
1138 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1139 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1140 {
1141 struct font_metrics metrics;
1142
1143 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1144 {
1145 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1146 struct font *font = s->font;
1147 int i;
1148
1149 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1150 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1151 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1156
1157 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1158 }
1159 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1160 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1161 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1162 }
1163 else if (s->cmp)
1164 {
1165 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1166 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1167 }
1168 }
1169
1170
1171 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1172
1173 static inline void
1174 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1175 {
1176 XGCValues xgcv;
1177 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1178 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1179 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1180 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1181 }
1182
1183
1184 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1185 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1186 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1187 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1188 contains the first component of a composition. */
1189
1190 static void
1191 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1192 {
1193 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1194 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1195 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1196 {
1197 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1198
1199 if (s->stippled_p)
1200 {
1201 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1202 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1204 s->y + box_line_width,
1205 s->background_width,
1206 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1207 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1208 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1209 }
1210 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1211 || s->font_not_found_p
1212 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1213 || force_p)
1214 {
1215 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1216 s->background_width,
1217 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1218 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1219 }
1220 }
1221 }
1222
1223
1224 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1225
1226 static void
1227 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1228 {
1229 int i, x;
1230
1231 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1232 of S to the right of that box line. */
1233 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1234 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1235 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1236 else
1237 x = s->x;
1238
1239 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1240 loaded. */
1241 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1242 {
1243 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1244 {
1245 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1246 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1247 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1248 s->height - 1);
1249 x += g->pixel_width;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 else
1253 {
1254 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1256 int y;
1257
1258 if (font->vertical_centering)
1259 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1260
1261 y = s->ybase - boff;
1262 if (s->for_overlaps
1263 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1264 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1265 else
1266 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1268 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1269 }
1270 }
1271
1272 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1273
1274 static void
1275 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1276 {
1277 int i, j, x;
1278 struct font *font = s->font;
1279
1280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1281 of S to the right of that box line. */
1282 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1284 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1285 else
1286 x = s->x;
1287
1288 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1289 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1290 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1291 this composition. */
1292
1293 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1294 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1295 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1296 {
1297 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1298 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1299 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1300 }
1301 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1302 {
1303 int y = s->ybase;
1304
1305 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1306 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1307 space on the left or right. */
1308 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1309 {
1310 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1311 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1312
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1314 if (s->face->overstrike)
1315 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1316 }
1317 }
1318 else
1319 {
1320 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1321 Lisp_Object glyph;
1322 int y = s->ybase;
1323 int width = 0;
1324
1325 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1326 {
1327 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1328 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1329 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1330 else
1331 {
1332 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1333
1334 if (j < i)
1335 {
1336 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1337 if (s->face->overstrike)
1338 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1339 x += width;
1340 }
1341 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1342 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1343 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1344 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1345 if (s->face->overstrike)
1346 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1347 x += wadjust;
1348 j = i + 1;
1349 width = 0;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 if (j < i)
1353 {
1354 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1355 if (s->face->overstrike)
1356 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1357 }
1358 }
1359 }
1360
1361
1362 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1363
1364 static void
1365 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1366 {
1367 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1368 XChar2b char2b[8];
1369 int x, i, j;
1370
1371 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1372 of S to the right of that box line. */
1373 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1374 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1375 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1376 else
1377 x = s->x;
1378
1379 s->char2b = char2b;
1380
1381 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1382 {
1383 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1384 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1385
1386 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1387 {
1388 if (len > 0
1389 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1390 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1391 >= 1))
1392 {
1393 Lisp_Object acronym
1394 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1395 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1396 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1397 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1398 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1399 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1400 }
1401 }
1402 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1403 {
1404 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1405 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1406 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1407 str = buf;
1408 }
1409
1410 if (str)
1411 {
1412 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1413 unsigned code;
1414
1415 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1416 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1417 {
1418 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1419 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1420 }
1421 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1422 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1423 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1424 0);
1425 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1426 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1427 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1428 0);
1429 }
1430 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1431 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1432 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1433 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1434 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1435 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1436 }
1437 }
1438
1439 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1440
1441 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1442 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1443 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1444 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1445
1446 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1447
1448 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1449 cannot be determined. */
1450
1451 static struct frame *
1452 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1453 {
1454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1455 Lisp_Object tail;
1456 struct frame *f;
1457
1458 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1459
1460 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1461 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1462 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1463 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1464 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1465 widget = XtParent (widget);
1466
1467 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1468 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1469 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1470 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1471 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1472 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1473 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1474 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1475 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1476 return f;
1477
1478 abort ();
1479 }
1480
1481 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1482 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1483 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1484 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1485 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1486 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1487
1488 int
1489 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1490 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1491 {
1492 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1493 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1494 }
1495
1496 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1497
1498
1499 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1501
1502 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1503 {
1504 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1505 sizeof (Screen *)},
1506 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1507 sizeof (Colormap)}
1508 };
1509
1510
1511 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1512 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1513
1514 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1515
1516
1517 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1518
1519 DPY is the display we are working on.
1520
1521 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1522 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1523 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1524 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1525
1526 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1527 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1528
1529 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1530 we allocated the color or not.
1531
1532 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1533
1534 static Boolean
1535 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1536 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1537 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1538 {
1539 Screen *screen;
1540 Colormap cmap;
1541 Pixel pixel;
1542 String color_name;
1543 XColor color;
1544
1545 if (*nargs != 2)
1546 {
1547 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1548 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1549 "XtToolkitError",
1550 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1551 return False;
1552 }
1553
1554 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1555 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1556 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1557
1558 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1559 {
1560 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1561 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1562 }
1563 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1564 {
1565 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1566 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1567 }
1568 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1569 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1570 {
1571 pixel = color.pixel;
1572 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1573 }
1574 else
1575 {
1576 String params[1];
1577 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1578
1579 params[0] = color_name;
1580 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1581 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1582 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1583 params, &nparams);
1584 return False;
1585 }
1586
1587 if (to->addr != NULL)
1588 {
1589 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1590 {
1591 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1592 return False;
1593 }
1594
1595 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1596 }
1597 else
1598 {
1599 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1600 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1601 }
1602
1603 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1604 return True;
1605 }
1606
1607
1608 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1609 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1610 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1611
1612 APP is the application context in which we work.
1613
1614 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1615 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1616 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1617
1618 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1619
1620 static void
1621 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1622 Cardinal *nargs)
1623 {
1624 if (*nargs != 2)
1625 {
1626 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1627 "XtToolkitError",
1628 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1629 NULL, NULL);
1630 }
1631 else if (closure != NULL)
1632 {
1633 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1634 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1635 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1636 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1637 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1638 }
1639 }
1640
1641
1642 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1643
1644
1645 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1646 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1647 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1648 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1649
1650 static const XColor *
1651 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1652 {
1653 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1654
1655 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1656 {
1657 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1658 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1659 int i;
1660
1661 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1662 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1663 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1664
1665 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1666 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1667
1668 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1669 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1670 }
1671
1672 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1673 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1674 }
1675
1676
1677 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1678 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1679
1680 void
1681 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1682 {
1683 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1684
1685 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1686 {
1687 int i;
1688 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1689 {
1690 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1691 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1692 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1693 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1694 }
1695 }
1696 else
1697 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1698 }
1699
1700
1701 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1702 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1703
1704 void
1705 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1706 {
1707 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1708 }
1709
1710
1711 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1712 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1713 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1714 allocated. */
1715
1716 static int
1717 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1718 {
1719 int rc;
1720
1721 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1722 if (rc == 0)
1723 {
1724 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1725 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1726 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1727 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1728 int nearest, i;
1729 int max_color_delta = 255;
1730 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1731 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1732 int ncells;
1733 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1734
1735 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1736 {
1737 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1738 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1739 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1740 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1741
1742 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1743 {
1744 nearest = i;
1745 nearest_delta = delta;
1746 }
1747 }
1748
1749 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1750 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1751 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1752 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1753 }
1754 else
1755 {
1756 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1757 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1758 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1759 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1760 XColor *cached_color;
1761
1762 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1763 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1764 (cached_color->red != color->red
1765 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1766 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1767 {
1768 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1769 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1770 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1771 }
1772 }
1773
1774 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1775 if (rc)
1776 register_color (color->pixel);
1777 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1778
1779 return rc;
1780 }
1781
1782
1783 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1784 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1785 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1786 allocated. */
1787
1788 int
1789 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1790 {
1791 gamma_correct (f, color);
1792 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1793 }
1794
1795
1796 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1797 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1798 get color reference counts right. */
1799
1800 unsigned long
1801 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1802 {
1803 XColor color;
1804
1805 color.pixel = pixel;
1806 BLOCK_INPUT;
1807 x_query_color (f, &color);
1808 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1809 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1810 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1811 register_color (pixel);
1812 #endif
1813 return color.pixel;
1814 }
1815
1816
1817 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1818 boosted.
1819
1820 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1821 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1822 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1823 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1824 use an additional additive factor.
1825
1826 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1827 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1828 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1829
1830
1831 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1832 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1833 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1834 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1835 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1836 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1837
1838 static int
1839 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1840 {
1841 XColor color, new;
1842 long bright;
1843 int success_p;
1844
1845 /* Get RGB color values. */
1846 color.pixel = *pixel;
1847 x_query_color (f, &color);
1848
1849 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1850 eassert (factor >= 0);
1851 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1852 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1853 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1854
1855 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1856 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1857
1858 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1859 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1860 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1861 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1862 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1863 {
1864 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1865 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1866 /* The additive adjustment. */
1867 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1868
1869 if (factor < 1)
1870 {
1871 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1872 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1873 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1874 }
1875 else
1876 {
1877 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1878 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1879 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1880 }
1881 }
1882
1883 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1884 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1885 if (success_p)
1886 {
1887 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1888 {
1889 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1890 delta to the RGB values. */
1891 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1892
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1896 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1897 }
1898 else
1899 success_p = 1;
1900 *pixel = new.pixel;
1901 }
1902
1903 return success_p;
1904 }
1905
1906
1907 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1908 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1909 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1910 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1911 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1912 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1913
1914 static void
1915 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1916 {
1917 XGCValues xgcv;
1918 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1919 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1920 unsigned long pixel;
1921 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1922 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1923 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1924 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1925
1926 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1927 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1928
1929 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1930 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1931 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1932 if (relief->gc
1933 && relief->allocated_p)
1934 {
1935 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1936 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1937 }
1938
1939 /* Allocate new color. */
1940 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1941 pixel = background;
1942 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1943 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1944 {
1945 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1946 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1947 }
1948
1949 if (relief->gc == 0)
1950 {
1951 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1952 mask |= GCStipple;
1953 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1954 }
1955 else
1956 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1957 }
1958
1959
1960 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1961
1962 static void
1963 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1964 {
1965 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1966 unsigned long color;
1967
1968 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1969 color = s->face->box_color;
1970 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1971 && s->img->pixmap
1972 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1973 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1974 else
1975 {
1976 XGCValues xgcv;
1977
1978 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1979 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1980 color = xgcv.background;
1981 }
1982
1983 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1984 || color != di->relief_background)
1985 {
1986 di->relief_background = color;
1987 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1988 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1989 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1990 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1991 }
1992 }
1993
1994
1995 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1996 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1997 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1998 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1999 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2000 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2001 when drawing. */
2002
2003 static void
2004 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2005 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2006 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2007 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2008 {
2009 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2010 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2011 int i;
2012 GC gc;
2013
2014 if (raised_p)
2015 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2016 else
2017 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2018 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2019
2020 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2021 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2022 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2023 corner pixels. */
2024
2025 /* Top. */
2026 if (top_p)
2027 {
2028 if (width == 1)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2030 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2031 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2032
2033 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2034 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2035 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2036 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2037 }
2038
2039 /* Left. */
2040 if (left_p)
2041 {
2042 if (width == 1)
2043 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2044
2045 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2046 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2047
2048 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051 }
2052
2053 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2054 if (raised_p)
2055 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2056 else
2057 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2058 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2059
2060 if (width > 1)
2061 {
2062 /* Outermost top line. */
2063 if (top_p)
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2066 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2067
2068 /* Outermost left line. */
2069 if (left_p)
2070 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2071 }
2072
2073 /* Bottom. */
2074 if (bot_p)
2075 {
2076 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2077 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2078 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2079 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2080 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2081 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2082 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2083 }
2084
2085 /* Right. */
2086 if (right_p)
2087 {
2088 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2089 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2090 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2091 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2092 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2093 }
2094
2095 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2096 }
2097
2098
2099 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2100 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2101 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2102 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2103 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2104 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2105
2106 static void
2107 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2108 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2109 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2110 {
2111 XGCValues xgcv;
2112
2113 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2115 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2116
2117 /* Top. */
2118 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2119 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2120
2121 /* Left. */
2122 if (left_p)
2123 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2124 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2125
2126 /* Bottom. */
2127 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2128 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2129
2130 /* Right. */
2131 if (right_p)
2132 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2133 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2134
2135 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2136 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2137 }
2138
2139
2140 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2141
2142 static void
2143 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2144 {
2145 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2146 int left_p, right_p;
2147 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2148 XRectangle clip_rect;
2149
2150 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2151 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2152 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2153
2154 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2155 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2156 ? s->first_glyph
2157 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2158
2159 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2160 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2161 left_x = s->x;
2162 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2163 ? last_x - 1
2164 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2165 top_y = s->y;
2166 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2167
2168 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2169 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2170 && (s->prev == NULL
2171 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2172 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2173 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2174 && (s->next == NULL
2175 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2176
2177 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2178
2179 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2180 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2181 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2182 else
2183 {
2184 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2185 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2186 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2187 }
2188 }
2189
2190
2191 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2192
2193 static void
2194 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2195 {
2196 int x = s->x;
2197 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2198
2199 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2200 right of that line. */
2201 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2202 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2203 && s->slice.x == 0)
2204 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2205
2206 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2207 by that margin. */
2208 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2209 x += s->img->hmargin;
2210 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2211 y += s->img->vmargin;
2212
2213 if (s->img->pixmap)
2214 {
2215 if (s->img->mask)
2216 {
2217 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2218 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2219 trust on the shape extension to be available
2220 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2221 manually. */
2222 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2223 | GCFunction);
2224 XGCValues xgcv;
2225 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2226
2227 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2228 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2229 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2230 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2231 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242 }
2243 else
2244 {
2245 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2246
2247 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2248 image_rect.x = x;
2249 image_rect.y = y;
2250 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2251 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2252 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2253 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2254 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2255 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2256
2257 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2258 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2259 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2260 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2261 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2262 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2263 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2264 {
2265 int relief = s->img->relief;
2266 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2267 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2268 x - relief, y - relief,
2269 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2270 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2271 }
2272 }
2273 }
2274 else
2275 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2276 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2277 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2278 }
2279
2280
2281 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2282
2283 static void
2284 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2285 {
2286 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2287 int extra_x, extra_y;
2288 XRectangle r;
2289 int x = s->x;
2290 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2291
2292 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2293 right of that line. */
2294 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2295 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2296 && s->slice.x == 0)
2297 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2298
2299 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2300 by that margin. */
2301 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += s->img->hmargin;
2303 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2304 y += s->img->vmargin;
2305
2306 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2307 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2308 {
2309 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2310 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2311 }
2312 else
2313 {
2314 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2315 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2316 }
2317
2318 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2319 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2320 {
2321 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2322 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2323 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2324 {
2325 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2326 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2327 }
2328 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2329 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2330 }
2331
2332 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2333 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2334 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2335 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2336
2337 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2338 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2339 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2340 s->slice.y == 0,
2341 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2342 s->slice.x == 0,
2343 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2344 &r);
2345 }
2346
2347
2348 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2349
2350 static void
2351 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2352 {
2353 int x = 0;
2354 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2355
2356 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2357 right of that line. */
2358 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2359 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2360 && s->slice.x == 0)
2361 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2362
2363 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2364 by that margin. */
2365 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2366 x += s->img->hmargin;
2367 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2368 y += s->img->vmargin;
2369
2370 if (s->img->pixmap)
2371 {
2372 if (s->img->mask)
2373 {
2374 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2375 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2376 trust on the shape extension to be available
2377 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2378 manually. */
2379 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2380 | GCFunction);
2381 XGCValues xgcv;
2382
2383 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2384 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2385 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2386 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2387 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2388
2389 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2390 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2391 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2392 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2393 }
2394 else
2395 {
2396 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2397 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2398 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2399
2400 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2401 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2402 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2403 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2404 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2405 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2406 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2407 {
2408 int r = s->img->relief;
2409 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2410 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2411 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2412 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2413 }
2414 }
2415 }
2416 else
2417 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2418 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2419 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2420 }
2421
2422
2423 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2424 give the rectangle to draw. */
2425
2426 static void
2427 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2428 {
2429 if (s->stippled_p)
2430 {
2431 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2432 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2433 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2434 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2435 }
2436 else
2437 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2438 }
2439
2440
2441 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2442
2443 s->y
2444 s->x +-------------------------
2445 | s->face->box
2446 |
2447 | +-------------------------
2448 | | s->img->margin
2449 | |
2450 | | +-------------------
2451 | | | the image
2452
2453 */
2454
2455 static void
2456 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2457 {
2458 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2459 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2460 int height;
2461 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2462
2463 height = s->height;
2464 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2465 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2466 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2467 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2468
2469 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2470 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2471 flickering. */
2472 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2473 if (height > s->slice.height
2474 || s->img->hmargin
2475 || s->img->vmargin
2476 || s->img->mask
2477 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2478 || s->width != s->background_width)
2479 {
2480 if (s->img->mask)
2481 {
2482 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2483 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2484 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2485 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2486 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2487
2488 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2489 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2490 s->background_width,
2491 s->height, depth);
2492
2493 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2494 pixmap. */
2495 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2496
2497 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2498 if (s->stippled_p)
2499 {
2500 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2501 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2502 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2503 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2504 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2505 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2506 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2507 }
2508 else
2509 {
2510 XGCValues xgcv;
2511 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2512 &xgcv);
2513 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2514 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2515 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2516 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2517 }
2518 }
2519 else
2520 {
2521 int x = s->x;
2522 int y = s->y;
2523
2524 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2525 && s->slice.x == 0)
2526 x += box_line_hwidth;
2527
2528 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2529 y += box_line_vwidth;
2530
2531 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2532 }
2533
2534 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2535 }
2536
2537 /* Draw the foreground. */
2538 if (pixmap != None)
2539 {
2540 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2541 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2542 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2543 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2544 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2545 }
2546 else
2547 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2548
2549 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2550 if (s->img->relief
2551 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2552 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2553 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2554 }
2555
2556
2557 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2558
2559 static void
2560 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2561 {
2562 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2563
2564 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2565 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2566 {
2567 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2568 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2569 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2570 int x = s->x;
2571
2572 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2573 {
2574 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2575
2576 if (x < left_x)
2577 {
2578 background_width -= left_x - x;
2579 x = left_x;
2580 }
2581 }
2582 else
2583 {
2584 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2585 stretch glyph. */
2586 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2587
2588 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2589 background_width -= x - right_x;
2590 x += background_width;
2591 }
2592 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2593 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2594 x -= width;
2595
2596 /* Draw cursor. */
2597 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2598
2599 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2600 if (width < background_width)
2601 {
2602 int y = s->y;
2603 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2604 XRectangle r;
2605 GC gc;
2606
2607 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2608 x += width;
2609 else
2610 x = s->x;
2611 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2612 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2613 {
2614 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2615 gc = s->gc;
2616 }
2617 else
2618 gc = s->face->gc;
2619
2620 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2621 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2622
2623 if (s->face->stipple)
2624 {
2625 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2626 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2627 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2628 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2629 }
2630 else
2631 {
2632 XGCValues xgcv;
2633 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2634 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2635 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2636 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2637 }
2638 }
2639 }
2640 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2641 {
2642 int background_width = s->background_width;
2643 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2644
2645 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2646 except for header line and mode line. */
2647 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2648 {
2649 background_width -= left_x - x;
2650 x = left_x;
2651 }
2652 if (background_width > 0)
2653 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2654 }
2655
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 }
2658
2659 /*
2660 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2661
2662 x0 wave_length = 2
2663 --
2664 y0 * * * * *
2665 |* * * * * * * * *
2666 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2667
2668 */
2669
2670 static void
2671 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2672 {
2673 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2674 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2675 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2676
2677 dx = wave_length;
2678 dy = wave_height - 1;
2679 x0 = s->x;
2680 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2681 width = s->width;
2682 xmax = x0 + width;
2683
2684 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2685
2686 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2687 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2688
2689 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2690 return;
2691
2692 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2693
2694 /* Draw the waves */
2695
2696 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2697 x2 = x1 + dx;
2698 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2699 y1 = y2 = y0;
2700
2701 if (odd)
2702 y1 += dy;
2703 else
2704 y2 += dy;
2705
2706 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2707 abort ();
2708
2709 while (x1 <= xmax)
2710 {
2711 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2712 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2713 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2714 odd = !odd;
2715 }
2716
2717 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2718 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2719 }
2720
2721
2722 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2723
2724 static void
2725 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2726 {
2727 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2728
2729 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2730 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2731 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2732 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2733 {
2734 int width;
2735 struct glyph_string *next;
2736
2737 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2738 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2739 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2740 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2741 {
2742 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2744 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2745 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2746 else
2747 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2748 next->num_clips = 0;
2749 }
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2753 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2754
2755 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2756 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2757 if (!s->for_overlaps
2758 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2759 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2760 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2761
2762 {
2763 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2764 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2765 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2766 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2767 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2768 }
2769 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2770 && !s->clip_tail
2771 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2772 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2773 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2774 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2775 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2776 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2777 else
2778 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2779
2780 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2781 {
2782 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2783 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2784 break;
2785
2786 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2787 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2788 break;
2789
2790 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2791 if (s->for_overlaps)
2792 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2793 else
2794 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2795 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2796 break;
2797
2798 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2799 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2800 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2801 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2802 else
2803 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2804 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2805 break;
2806
2807 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2808 if (s->for_overlaps)
2809 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2810 else
2811 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2812 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2813 break;
2814
2815 default:
2816 abort ();
2817 }
2818
2819 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2820 {
2821 /* Draw underline. */
2822 if (s->face->underline_p)
2823 {
2824 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2825 {
2826 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2827 x_draw_underwave (s);
2828 else
2829 {
2830 XGCValues xgcv;
2831 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2833 x_draw_underwave (s);
2834 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2835 }
2836 }
2837 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2838 {
2839 unsigned long thickness, position;
2840 int y;
2841
2842 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2843 {
2844 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2845 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2846 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2847 }
2848 else
2849 {
2850 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2851 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2852 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2853 else
2854 thickness = 1;
2855 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2856 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2857 else
2858 {
2859 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2860 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2861 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2862 specs, and its default is
2863
2864 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2865 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2866
2867 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2868 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2869 position = s->font->underline_position;
2870 else if (s->font)
2871 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2872 else
2873 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2874 }
2875 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2876 }
2877 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2878 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2879 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2880 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2881 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2882 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2883 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2884 s->underline_position = position;
2885 y = s->ybase + position;
2886 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2887 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2888 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2889 else
2890 {
2891 XGCValues xgcv;
2892 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2893 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2895 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2897 }
2898 }
2899 }
2900 /* Draw overline. */
2901 if (s->face->overline_p)
2902 {
2903 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2904
2905 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2906 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2907 s->width, h);
2908 else
2909 {
2910 XGCValues xgcv;
2911 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2912 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2913 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2914 s->width, h);
2915 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2916 }
2917 }
2918
2919 /* Draw strike-through. */
2920 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2921 {
2922 unsigned long h = 1;
2923 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2924
2925 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2926 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2927 s->width, h);
2928 else
2929 {
2930 XGCValues xgcv;
2931 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2932 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2933 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2934 s->width, h);
2935 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2936 }
2937 }
2938
2939 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2940 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2941 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2942
2943 if (s->prev)
2944 {
2945 struct glyph_string *prev;
2946
2947 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2948 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2949 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2950 {
2951 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2952 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2953 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2954
2955 prev->hl = s->hl;
2956 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2957 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2958 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2959 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2960 else
2961 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2962 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2963 prev->hl = save;
2964 prev->num_clips = 0;
2965 }
2966 }
2967
2968 if (s->next)
2969 {
2970 struct glyph_string *next;
2971
2972 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2973 if (next->hl != s->hl
2974 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2975 {
2976 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2977 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2978 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2979
2980 next->hl = s->hl;
2981 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2982 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2983 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2984 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2985 else
2986 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2987 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2988 next->hl = save;
2989 next->num_clips = 0;
2990 }
2991 }
2992 }
2993
2994 /* Reset clipping. */
2995 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2996 s->num_clips = 0;
2997 }
2998
2999 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3000
3001 static void
3002 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
3003 {
3004 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3005 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3006 x, y, width, height,
3007 x + shift_by, y);
3008 }
3009
3010 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3011 for X frames. */
3012
3013 static void
3014 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3015 {
3016 abort ();
3017 }
3018
3019
3020 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3021 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3022
3023 void
3024 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3025 {
3026 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3027 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3028 }
3029
3030
3031 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3032
3033 static void
3034 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3035 {
3036 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3037 longer visible. */
3038 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3039 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3040 output_cursor.x = -1;
3041
3042 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3043 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3044 BLOCK_INPUT;
3045
3046 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3047
3048 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3049 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3050 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3051
3052 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3053 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3054 redisplay, do it here. */
3055 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3056 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3057 #endif
3058
3059 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3060
3061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3062 }
3063
3064
3065 \f
3066 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3067
3068 static void
3069 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3070 {
3071 BLOCK_INPUT;
3072
3073 {
3074 #ifdef USE_GTK
3075 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3076 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3077 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3078 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3079 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3080 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3081 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3082 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3083 do { \
3084 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3085 cairo_fill (cr); \
3086 } \
3087 while (0)
3088 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3089 GdkGCValues vals;
3090 GdkGC *gc;
3091 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3092 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3093 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3094 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3095 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3096 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3097 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3098 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3099 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3100 GC gc;
3101
3102 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3103 pixels into background pixels. */
3104 {
3105 XGCValues values;
3106
3107 values.function = GXxor;
3108 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3109 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3110
3111 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3112 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3113 }
3114 #endif
3115 {
3116 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3117 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3118 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3119 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3120 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3121 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3122 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3123
3124 int width;
3125
3126 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3127 edge it is next to. */
3128 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3129 {
3130 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3131 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3132 break;
3133
3134 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3135 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3136 break;
3137
3138 default:
3139 break;
3140 }
3141
3142 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3143
3144 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3145 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3146 {
3147 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3148 flash_left,
3149 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3150 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3151 width, flash_height);
3152 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3153 flash_left,
3154 (height - flash_height
3155 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3156 width, flash_height);
3157
3158 }
3159 else
3160 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3161 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3162 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3163 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3164
3165 x_flush (f);
3166
3167 {
3168 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3169 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3170
3171 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3172 available. */
3173 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3174 {
3175 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3176 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3177
3178 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3179 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3180 break;
3181
3182 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3183 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3184
3185 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3186 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3187 }
3188 }
3189
3190 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3191 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3192 {
3193 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3194 flash_left,
3195 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3196 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3197 width, flash_height);
3198 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3199 flash_left,
3200 (height - flash_height
3201 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3202 width, flash_height);
3203 }
3204 else
3205 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3206 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3207 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3208 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3209
3210 #ifdef USE_GTK
3211 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3212 cairo_destroy (cr);
3213 #else
3214 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3215 #endif
3216 #undef XFillRectangle
3217 #else
3218 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3219 #endif
3220 x_flush (f);
3221 }
3222 }
3223
3224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3225 }
3226
3227
3228 static void
3229 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3230 {
3231 BLOCK_INPUT;
3232 if (invisible)
3233 {
3234 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3235 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3236 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3237 }
3238 else
3239 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3240 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3241 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3243 }
3244
3245
3246 /* Make audible bell. */
3247
3248 static void
3249 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3250 {
3251 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3252 {
3253 if (visible_bell)
3254 XTflash (f);
3255 else
3256 {
3257 BLOCK_INPUT;
3258 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3259 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3260 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3261 }
3262 }
3263 }
3264
3265 \f
3266 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3267 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3268 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3269 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3270
3271 static void
3272 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3273 {
3274 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3275 }
3276
3277
3278 \f
3279 /***********************************************************************
3280 Line Dance
3281 ***********************************************************************/
3282
3283 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3284 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3285
3286 static void
3287 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3288 {
3289 abort ();
3290 }
3291
3292
3293 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3294
3295 static void
3296 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3297 {
3298 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3299 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3300
3301 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3302 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3303 fringe of W. */
3304 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3305
3306 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3307 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3308 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3309 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3310 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3311 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3312 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3313 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3314 {
3315 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3316
3317 if (sb_width > 0)
3318 {
3319 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3320 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3321 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3322
3323 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3324 {
3325 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3326 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3327 }
3328 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3329 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 #endif
3333
3334 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3335 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3336 bottom_y = y + height;
3337
3338 if (to_y < from_y)
3339 {
3340 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3341 line at the bottom. */
3342 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3343 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3344 else
3345 height = run->height;
3346 }
3347 else
3348 {
3349 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3350 at the bottom. */
3351 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3352 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3353 else
3354 height = run->height;
3355 }
3356
3357 BLOCK_INPUT;
3358
3359 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3360 updated_window = w;
3361 x_clear_cursor (w);
3362
3363 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3364 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3365 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3366 x, from_y,
3367 width, height,
3368 x, to_y);
3369
3370 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3371 }
3372
3373
3374 \f
3375 /***********************************************************************
3376 Exposure Events
3377 ***********************************************************************/
3378
3379 \f
3380 static void
3381 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3382 {
3383 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3384 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3385 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3386 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3387 BLOCK_INPUT;
3388 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3389 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3390 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3391 because of this (bug#9310). */
3392 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3393 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3394 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3395 x_uncatch_errors ();
3396 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3397 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3398 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3399 }
3400
3401 static void
3402 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3403 {
3404 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3405 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3406 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3407 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3408 BLOCK_INPUT;
3409 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3410 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3411 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3412 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3413 x_uncatch_errors ();
3414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3415 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3416 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3417 }
3418
3419 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3420 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3421 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3422 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3423 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3424
3425 static void
3426 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3427 {
3428 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3429
3430 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3431 {
3432 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3433 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3434 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3435
3436 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3437 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3438
3439 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3440 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3441 else
3442 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3443 }
3444
3445 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3446 }
3447
3448 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3449 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3450 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3451
3452 static void
3453 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3454 {
3455 if (type == FocusIn)
3456 {
3457 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3458 {
3459 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3460 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3461
3462 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3463 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3464 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3465 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3466 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3467 {
3468 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3469 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3470 }
3471 }
3472
3473 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3474
3475 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3476 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3477 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3478 #endif
3479 }
3480 else if (type == FocusOut)
3481 {
3482 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3483
3484 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3485 {
3486 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3487 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3488 }
3489
3490 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3491 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3492 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3493 #endif
3494 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3495 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3496 }
3497 }
3498
3499 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3500 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3501
3502 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3503
3504 static void
3505 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3506 {
3507 struct frame *frame;
3508
3509 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3510 if (! frame)
3511 return;
3512
3513 switch (event->type)
3514 {
3515 case EnterNotify:
3516 case LeaveNotify:
3517 {
3518 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3519 int focus_state
3520 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3521
3522 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3523 && event->xcrossing.focus
3524 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3525 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3526 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3527 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3528 }
3529 break;
3530
3531 case FocusIn:
3532 case FocusOut:
3533 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3534 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3535 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3536 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3537 break;
3538
3539 case ClientMessage:
3540 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3541 {
3542 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3543 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3544 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3545 }
3546 break;
3547 }
3548 }
3549
3550
3551 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3552 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3553
3554 void
3555 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3556 {
3557 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3558 }
3559 #endif
3560
3561 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3562 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3563 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3564
3565 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3566 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3567 the appropriate X display info. */
3568
3569 static void
3570 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3571 {
3572 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3573 }
3574
3575 static void
3576 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3577 {
3578 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3579
3580 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3581 {
3582 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3583 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3584 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3585 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3586 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3587 {
3588 FSET (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, focus_frame, Qnil);
3589 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3590 }
3591 }
3592 else
3593 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3594
3595 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3596 {
3597 if (old_highlight)
3598 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3599 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3600 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3601 }
3602 }
3603
3604
3605 \f
3606 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3607
3608 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3609 static void
3610 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3611 {
3612 int min_code, max_code;
3613 KeySym *syms;
3614 int syms_per_code;
3615 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3616
3617 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3618 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3619 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3620 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3621 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3622
3623 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3624
3625 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3626 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3627 &syms_per_code);
3628 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3629
3630 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3631 Alt keysyms are on. */
3632 {
3633 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3634 int found_alt_or_meta;
3635
3636 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3637 {
3638 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3639 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3640 {
3641 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3642
3643 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3644 if (code == 0)
3645 continue;
3646
3647 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3648 {
3649 int code_col;
3650
3651 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3652 {
3653 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3654
3655 switch (sym)
3656 {
3657 case XK_Meta_L:
3658 case XK_Meta_R:
3659 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3660 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3661 break;
3662
3663 case XK_Alt_L:
3664 case XK_Alt_R:
3665 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3666 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3667 break;
3668
3669 case XK_Hyper_L:
3670 case XK_Hyper_R:
3671 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3672 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3673 code_col = syms_per_code;
3674 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3675 break;
3676
3677 case XK_Super_L:
3678 case XK_Super_R:
3679 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3680 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3681 code_col = syms_per_code;
3682 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3683 break;
3684
3685 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3686 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3687 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3688 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3689 code_col = syms_per_code;
3690 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3691 break;
3692 }
3693 }
3694 }
3695 }
3696 }
3697 }
3698
3699 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3700 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3701 {
3702 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3703 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3704 }
3705
3706 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3707 make them just meta, not alt. */
3708 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3709 {
3710 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3711 }
3712
3713 XFree (syms);
3714 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3715 }
3716
3717 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3718 Emacs uses. */
3719
3720 int
3721 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3722 {
3723 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3724 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3725 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3726 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3727 Lisp_Object tem;
3728
3729 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3730 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3731 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3732 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3733 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3734 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3735 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3736 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3737
3738 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3739 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3740 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3741 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3742 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3743 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3744 }
3745
3746 static int
3747 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3748 {
3749 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3750 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3751 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3752 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3753
3754 Lisp_Object tem;
3755
3756 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3757 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3758 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3759 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3760 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3761 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3762 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3763 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3764
3765
3766 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3767 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3768 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3769 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3770 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3771 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3775
3776 char *
3777 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3778 {
3779 char *value;
3780
3781 BLOCK_INPUT;
3782 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3783 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3784
3785 return value;
3786 }
3787
3788
3789 \f
3790 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3791
3792 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3793
3794 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3795 the mouse. */
3796
3797 static Lisp_Object
3798 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3799 {
3800 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3801 otherwise. */
3802 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3803 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3804 result->timestamp = event->time;
3805 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3806 event->state)
3807 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3808 ? up_modifier
3809 : down_modifier));
3810
3811 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3812 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3813 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3814 result->arg = Qnil;
3815 return Qnil;
3816 }
3817
3818 \f
3819 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3820 The input handler calls this.
3821
3822 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3823 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3824 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3825 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3826
3827 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3828 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3829
3830 static int
3831 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3832 {
3833 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3834 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3835 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3836
3837 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3838 return 0;
3839
3840 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3841 {
3842 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3843 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3844 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3845 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3846 return 1;
3847 }
3848
3849
3850 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3851 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3852 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3853 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3854 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3855 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3856 {
3857 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3858 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3859 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3860 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3861 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3862 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3863 return 1;
3864 }
3865
3866 return 0;
3867 }
3868
3869 \f
3870 /************************************************************************
3871 Mouse Face
3872 ************************************************************************/
3873
3874 static void
3875 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3876 {
3877 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3878 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3879 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3880 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3881 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3882 }
3883
3884
3885
3886 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3887 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3888
3889 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3890 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3891 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3892 position on the scroll bar.
3893
3894 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3895 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3896 the mouse is over.
3897
3898 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3899 was at this position.
3900
3901 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3902
3903 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3904 movement. */
3905
3906 static void
3907 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3908 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3909 Time *timestamp)
3910 {
3911 FRAME_PTR f1;
3912
3913 BLOCK_INPUT;
3914
3915 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3916 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3917 else
3918 {
3919 Window root;
3920 int root_x, root_y;
3921
3922 Window dummy_window;
3923 int dummy;
3924
3925 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3926
3927 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3928 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3929 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3930 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3931 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3932
3933 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3934
3935 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3936 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3937 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3938
3939 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3940 &root,
3941
3942 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3943 a different screen. */
3944 &dummy_window,
3945
3946 /* The position on that root window. */
3947 &root_x, &root_y,
3948
3949 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3950 &dummy, &dummy,
3951
3952 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3953 we don't care. */
3954 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3955
3956 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3957 containing the pointer. */
3958 {
3959 Window win, child;
3960 int win_x, win_y;
3961 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3962
3963 win = root;
3964
3965 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3966 structure is changing at the same time this function
3967 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3968
3969 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3970
3971 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3972 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3973 {
3974 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3975 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3976 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3977
3978 /* From-window, to-window. */
3979 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3980
3981 /* From-position, to-position. */
3982 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3983
3984 /* Child of win. */
3985 &child);
3986 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3987 }
3988 else
3989 {
3990 while (1)
3991 {
3992 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3993
3994 /* From-window, to-window. */
3995 root, win,
3996
3997 /* From-position, to-position. */
3998 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3999
4000 /* Child of win. */
4001 &child);
4002
4003 if (child == None || child == win)
4004 break;
4005 #ifdef USE_GTK
4006 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4007 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4008 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4009 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4010 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
4011 break;
4012 #endif
4013 win = child;
4014 parent_x = win_x;
4015 parent_y = win_y;
4016 }
4017
4018 /* Now we know that:
4019 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4020 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4021 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4022 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4023 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4024 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4025 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4026 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4027 never use them in that case.) */
4028
4029 #ifdef USE_GTK
4030 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4031 want the edit window. */
4032 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4033 #else
4034 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4035 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4036 #endif
4037
4038 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4039 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4040 on the frame. */
4041 if (f1 != NULL
4042 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4043 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4044 f1 = NULL;
4045 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4046 }
4047
4048 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4049 f1 = 0;
4050
4051 x_uncatch_errors ();
4052
4053 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4054 if (! f1)
4055 {
4056 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4057
4058 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4059
4060 if (bar)
4061 {
4062 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4063 win_x = parent_x;
4064 win_y = parent_y;
4065 }
4066 }
4067
4068 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4069 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4070
4071 if (f1)
4072 {
4073 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4074 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4075 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4076 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4077 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4078 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4079 the frame are divided into. */
4080
4081 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4082 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4083
4084 *bar_window = Qnil;
4085 *part = 0;
4086 *fp = f1;
4087 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4088 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4089 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4090 }
4091 }
4092 }
4093
4094 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4095 }
4096
4097
4098 \f
4099 /***********************************************************************
4100 Scroll bars
4101 ***********************************************************************/
4102
4103 /* Scroll bar support. */
4104
4105 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4106 manages it.
4107 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4108 bits. */
4109
4110 static struct scroll_bar *
4111 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4112 {
4113 Lisp_Object tail;
4114
4115 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4116 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4117 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4118
4119 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4120 {
4121 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4122
4123 frame = XCAR (tail);
4124 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4125 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4126 abort ();
4127
4128 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4129 continue;
4130
4131 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4132 right window ID. */
4133 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4134 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4135 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4136 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4137 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4138 condemned = Qnil,
4139 ! NILP (bar));
4140 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4141 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4142 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4143 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4144 }
4145
4146 return NULL;
4147 }
4148
4149
4150 #if defined USE_LUCID
4151
4152 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4153 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4154
4155 static Widget
4156 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4157 {
4158 Lisp_Object tail;
4159
4160 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4161 {
4162 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4163 {
4164 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4165 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4166
4167 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4168 return menu_bar;
4169 }
4170 }
4171
4172 return NULL;
4173 }
4174
4175 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4176
4177 \f
4178 /************************************************************************
4179 Toolkit scroll bars
4180 ************************************************************************/
4181
4182 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4183
4184 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4185 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4186 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4187 struct scroll_bar *);
4188 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4189 int, int, int);
4190
4191
4192 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4193 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4194
4195 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4196
4197 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4198
4199 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4200
4201 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4202 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4203
4204 #ifndef USE_GTK
4205 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4206
4207 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4208
4209 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4210
4211 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4212 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4213 to avoid jerkiness. */
4214
4215 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4216
4217 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4218 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4219 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4220 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4221
4222 static void
4223 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4224 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4225 {
4226 int scroll_bar_p;
4227 const char *end_action;
4228
4229 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4230 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4231 end_action = "Release";
4232 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4233 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4234 end_action = "EndScroll";
4235 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4236
4237 if (scroll_bar_p
4238 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4239 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4240 {
4241 struct window *w;
4242
4243 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4244 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4245 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4246
4247 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4248 {
4249 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4250 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4251 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4252 }
4253 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4254 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4255
4256 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4257 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4258 }
4259 }
4260 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4261
4262 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4263 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4264
4265 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4266 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4267
4268
4269 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4270 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4271 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4272 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4273
4274 static void
4275 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4276 {
4277 XEvent event;
4278 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4279 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4280 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4281 ptrdiff_t i;
4282
4283 BLOCK_INPUT;
4284
4285 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4286 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4287 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4288 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4289 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4290 ev->format = 32;
4291
4292 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4293 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4294 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4295 into that array in the event. */
4296 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4297 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4298 break;
4299
4300 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4301 {
4302 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4303 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4304 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4305 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4306 scroll_bar_windows =
4307 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4308 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4309 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4310 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4311 }
4312
4313 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4314 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4315 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4316 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4317 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4318 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4319
4320 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4321 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4322 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4323 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4324 #endif
4325
4326 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4327 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4328 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4329 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4331 }
4332
4333
4334 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4335 in *IEVENT. */
4336
4337 static void
4338 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4339 {
4340 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4341 Lisp_Object window;
4342 struct window *w;
4343
4344 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4345 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4346
4347 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4348
4349 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4350 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4351 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4352 #ifdef USE_GTK
4353 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4354 #else
4355 ievent->timestamp =
4356 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4357 #endif
4358 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4359 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4360 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4361 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4362 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4363 }
4364
4365
4366 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4367
4368 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4369
4370 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4371
4372
4373 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4374 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4375 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4376
4377 static void
4378 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4379 {
4380 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4381 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4382 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4383
4384 switch (cs->reason)
4385 {
4386 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4387 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4388 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4389 break;
4390
4391 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4392 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4393 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4394 break;
4395
4396 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4397 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4398 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4399 break;
4400
4401 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4402 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4403 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4404 break;
4405
4406 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4407 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4408 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4409 break;
4410
4411 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4412 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4413 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4414 break;
4415
4416 case XmCR_DRAG:
4417 {
4418 int slider_size;
4419
4420 /* Get the slider size. */
4421 BLOCK_INPUT;
4422 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4423 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4424
4425 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4426 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4427 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4428 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4429 }
4430 break;
4431
4432 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4433 break;
4434 };
4435
4436 if (part >= 0)
4437 {
4438 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4439 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4440 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4441 }
4442 }
4443
4444 #elif defined USE_GTK
4445
4446 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4447 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4448
4449 static gboolean
4450 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4451 GtkScrollType scroll,
4452 gdouble value,
4453 gpointer user_data)
4454 {
4455 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4456 gdouble position;
4457 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4458 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4459 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4460
4461 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4462 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4463
4464
4465 switch (scroll)
4466 {
4467 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4468 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4469 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4470 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4471 {
4472 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4473 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4474 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4475 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4476 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4477 }
4478 break;
4479 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4480 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4481 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4482 break;
4483 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4484 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4485 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4486 break;
4487 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4488 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4489 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4490 break;
4491 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4492 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4493 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4494 break;
4495 }
4496
4497 if (part >= 0)
4498 {
4499 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4500 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4501 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4502 }
4503
4504 return FALSE;
4505 }
4506
4507 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4508
4509 static gboolean
4510 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4511 GdkEventButton *event,
4512 gpointer user_data)
4513 {
4514 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4515 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4516 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4517 {
4518 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4519 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4520 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4521 }
4522
4523 return FALSE;
4524 }
4525
4526
4527 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4528
4529 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4530 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4531 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4532 the thumb is. */
4533
4534 static void
4535 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4536 {
4537 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4538 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4539 float shown;
4540 int whole, portion, height;
4541 int part;
4542
4543 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4544 BLOCK_INPUT;
4545 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4546 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4547
4548 whole = 10000000;
4549 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4550
4551 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4552 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4553 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4554 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4555 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4556 bottom). */
4557 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4558 else
4559 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4560
4561 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4562 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4563 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4564 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4565 }
4566
4567
4568 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4569 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4570 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4571 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4572 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4573 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4574 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4575
4576 static void
4577 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4578 {
4579 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4580 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4581 int position = (long) call_data;
4582 Dimension height;
4583 int part;
4584
4585 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4586 BLOCK_INPUT;
4587 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4588 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4589
4590 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4591 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4592
4593 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4594 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4595 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4596 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4597 else
4598 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4599
4600 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4601 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4602 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4603 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4604 }
4605
4606 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4607
4608 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4609
4610 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4611 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4612
4613 #ifdef USE_GTK
4614 static void
4615 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4616 {
4617 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4618
4619 BLOCK_INPUT;
4620 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4621 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4622 scroll_bar_name);
4623 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4624 }
4625
4626 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4627
4628 static void
4629 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4630 {
4631 Window xwindow;
4632 Widget widget;
4633 Arg av[20];
4634 int ac = 0;
4635 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4636 unsigned long pixel;
4637
4638 BLOCK_INPUT;
4639
4640 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4641 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4642 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4643 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4644 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4645 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4646 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4648 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4649
4650 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4651 if (pixel != -1)
4652 {
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4654 ++ac;
4655 }
4656
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4659 {
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4662 }
4663
4664 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4665 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4666
4667 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4668 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4669 (XtPointer) bar);
4670 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4671 (XtPointer) bar);
4672 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4673 (XtPointer) bar);
4674 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4675 (XtPointer) bar);
4676 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4677 (XtPointer) bar);
4678 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4679 (XtPointer) bar);
4680 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4681 (XtPointer) bar);
4682
4683 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4684 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4685
4686 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4687 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4688 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4689 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4690
4691 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4692
4693 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4694 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4695 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4696 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4697 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4698 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4699 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4700 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4701
4702 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4703 if (pixel != -1)
4704 {
4705 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4706 ++ac;
4707 }
4708
4709 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4710 if (pixel != -1)
4711 {
4712 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4713 ++ac;
4714 }
4715
4716 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4717
4718 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4719 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4720 {
4721 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4722 if (pixel != -1)
4723 {
4724 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4725 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4726 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4727 pixel = -1;
4728 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4729 }
4730 }
4731 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4732 {
4733 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4734 if (pixel != -1)
4735 {
4736 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4737 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4738 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4739 pixel = -1;
4740 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4745 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4746 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4747 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4748 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4749 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4750 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4751 colors itself. */
4752 {
4753 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4754 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4755 ++ac;
4756 }
4757 else
4758 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4759 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4760 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4761 {
4762 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4763 the shadows. */
4764 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4765 ++ac;
4766
4767 /* Specify the colors. */
4768 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4769 if (pixel != -1)
4770 {
4771 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4772 ++ac;
4773 }
4774 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4775 if (pixel != -1)
4776 {
4777 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4778 ++ac;
4779 }
4780 }
4781 #endif
4782
4783 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4784 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4785
4786 {
4787 char const *initial = "";
4788 char const *val = initial;
4789 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4790 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4791 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4792 #endif
4793 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4794 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4795 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4796 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4797 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4798 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4799 }
4800 }
4801
4802 /* Define callbacks. */
4803 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4804 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4805 (XtPointer) bar);
4806
4807 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4808 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4809
4810 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4811
4812 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4813 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4814 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4815 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4816
4817 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4818 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4819 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4820 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4821
4822 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4823 }
4824 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4825
4826
4827 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4828 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4829
4830 #ifdef USE_GTK
4831 static void
4832 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4833 {
4834 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4835 }
4836
4837 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4838 static void
4839 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4840 int whole)
4841 {
4842 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4843 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4844 float top, shown;
4845
4846 BLOCK_INPUT;
4847
4848 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4849
4850 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4851 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4852 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4853 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4854 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4855 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4856 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4857 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4858 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4859 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4860 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4861 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4862 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4863 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4864 whole += portion;
4865
4866 if (whole <= 0)
4867 top = 0, shown = 1;
4868 else
4869 {
4870 top = (float) position / whole;
4871 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4872 }
4873
4874 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4875 {
4876 int size, value;
4877
4878 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4879 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4880 value. */
4881 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4882 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4883 size = max (size, 1);
4884
4885 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4886 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4887 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4888
4889 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4890 }
4891 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4892
4893 if (whole == 0)
4894 top = 0, shown = 1;
4895 else
4896 {
4897 top = (float) position / whole;
4898 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4899 }
4900
4901 {
4902 float old_top, old_shown;
4903 Dimension height;
4904 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4905 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4906 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4907 XtNheight, &height,
4908 NULL);
4909
4910 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4911 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4912 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4913 else
4914 top = old_top;
4915 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4916 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4917
4918 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4919 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4920 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4921 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4922 {
4923 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4924 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4925 else
4926 {
4927 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4928 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4929 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4930
4931 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4932 }
4933 }
4934 }
4935 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4936
4937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4938 }
4939 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4940
4941 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4942
4943
4944 \f
4945 /************************************************************************
4946 Scroll bars, general
4947 ************************************************************************/
4948
4949 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4950 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4951 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4952 scroll bar. */
4953
4954 static struct scroll_bar *
4955 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4956 {
4957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4958 struct scroll_bar *bar
4959 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4960 Lisp_Object barobj;
4961
4962 BLOCK_INPUT;
4963
4964 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4965 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4966 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4967 {
4968 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4969 unsigned long mask;
4970 Window window;
4971
4972 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4973 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4974 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4975
4976 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4977 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4978 | ExposureMask);
4979 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4980
4981 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4982
4983 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4984 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4985 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4986 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4987 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4988 left, top, width,
4989 window_box_height (w), False);
4990
4991 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4992 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4993 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4994 top,
4995 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4996 height,
4997 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4998 0,
4999 CopyFromParent,
5000 CopyFromParent,
5001 CopyFromParent,
5002 /* Attributes. */
5003 mask, &a);
5004 bar->x_window = window;
5005 }
5006 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5007
5008 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5009 bar->top = top;
5010 bar->left = left;
5011 bar->width = width;
5012 bar->height = height;
5013 bar->start = 0;
5014 bar->end = 0;
5015 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5016 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5017
5018 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5019 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5020 bar->prev = Qnil;
5021 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5022 FSET (f, scroll_bars, barobj);
5023 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5024 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5025
5026 /* Map the window/widget. */
5027 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5028 {
5029 #ifdef USE_GTK
5030 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5031 bar->x_window,
5032 top,
5033 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5034 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5035 max (height, 1));
5036 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5037 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5038 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5039 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5040 top,
5041 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5042 max (height, 1), 0);
5043 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5044 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5045 }
5046 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5047 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5048 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5049
5050 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5051 return bar;
5052 }
5053
5054
5055 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5056
5057 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5058
5059 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5060 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5061 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5062 events.)
5063
5064 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5065 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5066 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5067 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5068 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5069
5070 static void
5071 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5072 {
5073 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5074 Window w = bar->x_window;
5075 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5076 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5077
5078 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5079 if (! rebuild
5080 && start == bar->start
5081 && end == bar->end)
5082 return;
5083
5084 BLOCK_INPUT;
5085
5086 {
5087 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5088 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5089 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5090
5091 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5092 the distance between start and end. */
5093 {
5094 int length = end - start;
5095
5096 if (start < 0)
5097 start = 0;
5098 else if (start > top_range)
5099 start = top_range;
5100 end = start + length;
5101
5102 if (end < start)
5103 end = start;
5104 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5105 end = top_range;
5106 }
5107
5108 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5109 bar->start = start;
5110 bar->end = end;
5111
5112 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5113 if (end > top_range)
5114 end = top_range;
5115
5116 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5117 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5118 that many pixels tall. */
5119 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5120
5121 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5122 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5123 if (0 < start)
5124 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5125 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5126 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5127 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5128 inside_width, start,
5129 False);
5130
5131 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5132 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5133 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5134 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5135
5136 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5137 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5138 /* x, y, width, height */
5139 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5140 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5141 inside_width, end - start);
5142
5143 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5144 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5145 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5146 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5147
5148 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5149 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5150 if (end < inside_height)
5151 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5152 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5153 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5154 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5155 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5156 False);
5157
5158 }
5159
5160 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5161 }
5162
5163 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5164
5165 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5166 nil. */
5167
5168 static void
5169 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5170 {
5171 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5172 BLOCK_INPUT;
5173
5174 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5175 #ifdef USE_GTK
5176 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5177 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5178 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5179 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5180 #else
5181 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5182 #endif
5183
5184 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5185 WSET (XWINDOW (bar->window), vertical_scroll_bar, Qnil);
5186
5187 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5188 }
5189
5190
5191 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5192 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5193 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5194 create one. */
5195
5196 static void
5197 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5198 {
5199 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5200 Lisp_Object barobj;
5201 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5202 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5203 int window_y, window_height;
5204 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5205 int fringe_extended_p;
5206 #endif
5207
5208 /* Get window dimensions. */
5209 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5210 top = window_y;
5211 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5212 height = window_height;
5213
5214 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5215 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5216
5217 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5218 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5219 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5220 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5221 else
5222 sb_width = width;
5223
5224 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5225 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5226 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5227 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5228 else
5229 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5230 #else
5231 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5232 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5233 else
5234 sb_left = left;
5235 #endif
5236
5237 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5238 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5239 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5240 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5241 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5242 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5243 else
5244 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5245 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5246 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5247 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5248 #endif
5249
5250 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5251 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 {
5253 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5254 {
5255 BLOCK_INPUT;
5256 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5257 if (fringe_extended_p)
5258 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5259 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5260 else
5261 #endif
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5263 left, top, width, height, False);
5264 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5265 }
5266
5267 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5268 }
5269 else
5270 {
5271 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5272 unsigned int mask = 0;
5273
5274 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5275
5276 BLOCK_INPUT;
5277
5278 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5279 mask |= CWX;
5280 if (top != bar->top)
5281 mask |= CWY;
5282 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5283 mask |= CWWidth;
5284 if (height != bar->height)
5285 mask |= CWHeight;
5286
5287 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5288
5289 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5290 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5291 {
5292 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5293 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5294 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5295 {
5296 if (fringe_extended_p)
5297 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5298 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5299 else
5300 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5301 left, top, width, height, False);
5302 }
5303 #ifdef USE_GTK
5304 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5305 bar->x_window,
5306 top,
5307 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5308 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5309 max (height, 1));
5310 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5311 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5312 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5313 top,
5314 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5315 max (height, 1), 0);
5316 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5317 }
5318 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5319
5320 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5321 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5322 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5323 {
5324 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5325 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5326 height, False);
5327 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5328 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5329 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5330 height, False);
5331 }
5332
5333 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5334 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5335 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5336 example. */
5337 {
5338 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5339 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5340 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5341 {
5342 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5343 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5344 left + area_width - rest, top,
5345 rest, height, False);
5346 else
5347 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5348 left, top, rest, height, False);
5349 }
5350 }
5351
5352 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5353 if (mask)
5354 {
5355 XWindowChanges wc;
5356
5357 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5358 wc.y = top;
5359 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5360 wc.height = height;
5361 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5362 mask, &wc);
5363 }
5364
5365 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5366
5367 /* Remember new settings. */
5368 bar->left = sb_left;
5369 bar->top = top;
5370 bar->width = sb_width;
5371 bar->height = height;
5372
5373 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5374 }
5375
5376 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5377 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5378
5379 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5380 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5381 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5382 dragged. */
5383 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5384 {
5385 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5386
5387 if (whole == 0)
5388 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5389 else
5390 {
5391 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5392 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5393 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5394 }
5395 }
5396 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5397
5398 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5399 WSET (w, vertical_scroll_bar, barobj);
5400 }
5401
5402
5403 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5404 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5405 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5406 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5407 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5408 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5409 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5410
5411 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5412 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5413 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5414
5415 static void
5416 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5417 {
5418 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5419 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5420 {
5421 Lisp_Object bar;
5422 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5423 FSET (frame, scroll_bars, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5424 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5425 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5426 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5427 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5428 FSET (frame, condemned_scroll_bars, bar);
5429 }
5430 }
5431
5432
5433 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5434 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5435
5436 static void
5437 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5438 {
5439 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5440 struct frame *f;
5441 Lisp_Object barobj;
5442
5443 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5444 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5445 abort ();
5446
5447 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5448
5449 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5450 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5451 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5452 {
5453 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5454 the lists. */
5455 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5456 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5457 return;
5458 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5459 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5460 FSET (f, condemned_scroll_bars, bar->next);
5461 else
5462 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5463 one or the other! */
5464 abort ();
5465 }
5466 else
5467 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5468
5469 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5470 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5471
5472 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5473 bar->prev = Qnil;
5474 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5475 FSET (f, scroll_bars, barobj);
5476 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5477 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5478 }
5479
5480 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5481 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5482
5483 static void
5484 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5485 {
5486 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5487
5488 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5489
5490 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5491 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5492 FSET (f, condemned_scroll_bars, Qnil);
5493
5494 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5495 {
5496 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5497
5498 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5499
5500 next = b->next;
5501 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5502 }
5503
5504 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5505 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5506 }
5507
5508
5509 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5510 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5511 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5512
5513 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5514 mark bits. */
5515
5516 static void
5517 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5518 {
5519 Window w = bar->x_window;
5520 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5521 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5522 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5523
5524 BLOCK_INPUT;
5525
5526 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5527
5528 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5529 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5530 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5531 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5532
5533 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5534 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5535
5536 /* x, y, width, height */
5537 0, 0,
5538 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5539 bar->height - 1);
5540
5541 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5542 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5543 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5544 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5545
5546 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5547
5548 }
5549 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5550
5551 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5552 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5553
5554 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5555 mark bits. */
5556
5557
5558 static void
5559 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5560 {
5561 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5562 abort ();
5563
5564 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5565 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5566 emacs_event->modifiers
5567 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5568 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5569 event->xbutton.state)
5570 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5571 ? up_modifier
5572 : down_modifier));
5573 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5574 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5575 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5576 {
5577 int top_range
5578 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5579 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5580
5581 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5582 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5583
5584 if (y < bar->start)
5585 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5586 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5587 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5588 else
5589 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5590
5591 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5592 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5593 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5594 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5595 {
5596 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5597 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5598
5599 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5600 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5601 }
5602 #endif
5603
5604 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5605 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5606 }
5607 }
5608
5609 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5610
5611 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5612
5613 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5614 mark bits. */
5615
5616 static void
5617 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5618 {
5619 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5620
5621 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5622
5623 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5624 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5625
5626 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5627 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5628 {
5629 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5630 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5631
5632 if (new_start != bar->start)
5633 {
5634 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5635
5636 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5637 }
5638 }
5639 }
5640
5641 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5642
5643 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5644 on the scroll bar. */
5645
5646 static void
5647 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5648 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5649 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5650 {
5651 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5652 Window w = bar->x_window;
5653 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5654 int win_x, win_y;
5655 Window dummy_window;
5656 int dummy_coord;
5657 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5658
5659 BLOCK_INPUT;
5660
5661 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5662 report that. */
5663 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5664
5665 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5666 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5667 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5668
5669 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5670 &win_x, &win_y,
5671
5672 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5673 &dummy_mask))
5674 ;
5675 else
5676 {
5677 int top_range
5678 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5679
5680 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5681
5682 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5683 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5684
5685 if (win_y < 0)
5686 win_y = 0;
5687 if (win_y > top_range)
5688 win_y = top_range;
5689
5690 *fp = f;
5691 *bar_window = bar->window;
5692
5693 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5694 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5695 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5696 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5697 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5698 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5699 else
5700 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5701
5702 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5703 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5704
5705 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5706 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5707 }
5708
5709 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5710
5711 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5712 }
5713
5714
5715 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5716 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5717 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5718 redraw them. */
5719
5720 static void
5721 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5722 {
5723 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5724 Lisp_Object bar;
5725
5726 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5727 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5728 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5729 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5730 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5731 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5732 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5733 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5734 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5735 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5736 }
5737
5738 \f
5739 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5740
5741 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5742 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5743 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5744 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5745
5746 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5747 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5748
5749 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5750
5751 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5752 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5753
5754 static int temp_index;
5755 static short temp_buffer[100];
5756
5757 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5758 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5759 temp_index = 0; \
5760 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5761
5762 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5763 on a particular display. */
5764
5765 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5766
5767 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5768 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5769 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5770 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5771
5772 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5773
5774 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5775 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5776 do \
5777 { \
5778 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5779 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5780 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5781 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5782 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5783 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5784 } \
5785 while (0)
5786 #endif
5787
5788 enum
5789 {
5790 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5791 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5792 X_EVENT_DROP
5793 };
5794
5795 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5796 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5797 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5798
5799 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5800 this event further.
5801 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5802
5803 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5804 static int
5805 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5806 {
5807 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5808 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5809 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5810 was created. */
5811
5812 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5813 event->xclient.window);
5814
5815 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5816 }
5817 #endif
5818
5819 #ifdef USE_GTK
5820 static int current_count;
5821 static int current_finish;
5822 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5823
5824 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5825 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5826 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5827 static GdkFilterReturn
5828 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5829 {
5830 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5831
5832 BLOCK_INPUT;
5833 if (current_count >= 0)
5834 {
5835 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5836
5837 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5838
5839 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5840 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5841 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5842 so we do it here. */
5843 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5844 && dpyinfo
5845 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5846 {
5847 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5848 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5849 }
5850 #endif
5851
5852 if (! dpyinfo)
5853 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5854 else
5855 current_count +=
5856 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5857 current_hold_quit);
5858 }
5859 else
5860 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5861
5862 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5863
5864 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5865 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5866
5867 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5868 }
5869 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5870
5871
5872 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5873 enum xembed_message,
5874 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5875
5876 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5877
5878 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5879 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5880 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5881
5882 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5883
5884 static int
5885 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5886 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5887 {
5888 union {
5889 struct input_event ie;
5890 struct selection_input_event sie;
5891 } inev;
5892 int count = 0;
5893 int do_help = 0;
5894 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5895 struct frame *f = NULL;
5896 struct coding_system coding;
5897 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5898 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5899 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5900
5901 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5902
5903 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5904 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5905 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5906
5907 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5908 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5909
5910 switch (event.type)
5911 {
5912 case ClientMessage:
5913 {
5914 if (event.xclient.message_type
5915 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5916 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5917 {
5918 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5919 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5920 {
5921 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5922 could be the shell widget window
5923 if the frame has no title bar. */
5924 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5925 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5926 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5927 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5928 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5929 #endif
5930 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5931 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5932 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5933 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5934 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5935 needed.
5936
5937 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5938 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5939 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5940 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5941 Emacs. */
5942
5943 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5944 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5945 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5946 if (f)
5947 {
5948 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5949 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5950 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5951 x_catch_errors (d);
5952 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5953 /* The ICCCM says this is
5954 the only valid choice. */
5955 RevertToParent,
5956 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5957 /* This is needed to detect the error
5958 if there is an error. */
5959 XSync (d, False);
5960 x_uncatch_errors ();
5961 }
5962 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5963 #endif /* 0 */
5964 goto done;
5965 }
5966
5967 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5968 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5969 {
5970 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5971 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5972 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5973 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5974 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5975 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5976 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5977 session manager and one for this. */
5978 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5979 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5980 #endif
5981 {
5982 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5983 event.xclient.window);
5984 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5985 for a single Emacs process. */
5986 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5987 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5988 event.xclient.window,
5989 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5990 else if (f)
5991 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5992 event.xclient.window,
5993 0, 0);
5994 }
5995 goto done;
5996 }
5997
5998 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5999 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6000 {
6001 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6002 event.xclient.window);
6003 if (!f)
6004 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6005
6006 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6007 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6008 goto done;
6009 }
6010
6011 goto done;
6012 }
6013
6014 if (event.xclient.message_type
6015 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6016 {
6017 goto done;
6018 }
6019
6020 if (event.xclient.message_type
6021 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6022 {
6023 int new_x, new_y;
6024 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6025
6026 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6027 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6028
6029 if (f)
6030 {
6031 f->left_pos = new_x;
6032 f->top_pos = new_y;
6033 }
6034 goto done;
6035 }
6036
6037 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6038 if (event.xclient.message_type
6039 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6040 {
6041 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6042 if (f)
6043 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6044 &event, NULL);
6045 goto done;
6046 }
6047 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6048
6049 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6050 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6051 || (event.xclient.message_type
6052 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6053 {
6054 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6055 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6056 currently never do because we are interested in
6057 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6058 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6059 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6060 if (!f)
6061 goto OTHER;
6062 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6063 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6064 goto done;
6065 }
6066
6067 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6068 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6069 we construct an input_event. */
6070 if (event.xclient.message_type
6071 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6072 {
6073 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6074 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6075 goto done;
6076 }
6077 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6078
6079 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6080 if (event.xclient.message_type
6081 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6082 {
6083 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6084 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6085 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6086
6087 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6088 goto done;
6089 }
6090
6091 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6092
6093 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6094 if (!f)
6095 goto OTHER;
6096 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6097 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6098 }
6099 break;
6100
6101 case SelectionNotify:
6102 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6103 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6104 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6105 goto OTHER;
6106 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6107 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6108 break;
6109
6110 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6111 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6112 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6113 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6114 goto OTHER;
6115 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6116 {
6117 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6118
6119 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6120 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6121 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6122 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6123 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6124 }
6125 break;
6126
6127 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6128 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6129 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6130 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6131 goto OTHER;
6132 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6133 {
6134 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6135
6136 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6137 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6138 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6139 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6140 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6141 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6142 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6143 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6144 }
6145 break;
6146
6147 case PropertyNotify:
6148 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6149 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6150 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6151 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6152 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6153 {
6154 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6155 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6156 treat it as deiconified. */
6157 if (! f->async_iconified)
6158 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6159 f->async_visible = 1;
6160 f->async_iconified = 0;
6161 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6162 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6163 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6164 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6165 }
6166
6167 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6168 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6169 goto OTHER;
6170
6171 case ReparentNotify:
6172 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6173 if (f)
6174 {
6175 int x, y;
6176 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6177 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6178 f->left_pos = x;
6179 f->top_pos = y;
6180
6181 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6182 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6183 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6184
6185 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6186 }
6187 goto OTHER;
6188
6189 case Expose:
6190 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6191 if (f)
6192 {
6193 #ifdef USE_GTK
6194 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6195 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6196 event.xexpose.window,
6197 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6198 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6199 FALSE);
6200 #endif
6201 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6202 {
6203 f->async_visible = 1;
6204 f->async_iconified = 0;
6205 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6206 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6207 }
6208 else
6209 expose_frame (f,
6210 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6211 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6212 }
6213 else
6214 {
6215 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6216 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6217 #endif
6218 #if defined USE_LUCID
6219 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6220 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6221 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6222 {
6223 Widget widget
6224 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6225 if (widget)
6226 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6227 }
6228 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6229
6230 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6231 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6232 goto OTHER;
6233 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6234 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6235 event.xexpose.window);
6236
6237 if (bar)
6238 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6239 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6240 else
6241 goto OTHER;
6242 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6243 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6244 }
6245 break;
6246
6247 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6248 source area was obscured or not
6249 available. */
6250 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6251 if (f)
6252 {
6253 expose_frame (f,
6254 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6255 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6256 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6257 }
6258 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6259 else
6260 goto OTHER;
6261 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6262 break;
6263
6264 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6265 source area was completely
6266 available. */
6267 break;
6268
6269 case UnmapNotify:
6270 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6271 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6272 {
6273 tip_window = 0;
6274 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6275 }
6276
6277 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6278 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6279 the frame was deleted. */
6280 {
6281 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6282 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6283 display that won't ever be seen. */
6284 f->async_visible = 0;
6285 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6286 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6287 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6288 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6289 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6290 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6291 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6292 {
6293 f->async_iconified = 1;
6294
6295 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6296 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6297 }
6298 }
6299 goto OTHER;
6300
6301 case MapNotify:
6302 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6303 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6304 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6305 goto OTHER;
6306
6307 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6308 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6309 frame is visible. */
6310 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6311 if (f)
6312 {
6313 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6314 the frame's display structures.
6315 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6316 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6317 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6318 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6319 if (! f->async_iconified)
6320 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6321
6322 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6323 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6324 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6325 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6326
6327 f->async_visible = 1;
6328 f->async_iconified = 0;
6329 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6330
6331 if (f->iconified)
6332 {
6333 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6334 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6335 }
6336 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6337 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6338 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6339 to update the frame titles
6340 in case this is the second frame. */
6341 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6342
6343 #ifdef USE_GTK
6344 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6345 #endif
6346 }
6347 goto OTHER;
6348
6349 case KeyPress:
6350
6351 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6352 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6353
6354 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6355 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6356 if (popup_activated ())
6357 goto OTHER;
6358 #endif
6359
6360 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6361
6362 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6363 mouse highlighting. */
6364 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6365 && (f == 0
6366 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6367 {
6368 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6369 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6370 }
6371
6372 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6373 if (f == 0)
6374 {
6375 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6376 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6377 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6378 event.xkey.window);
6379 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6380 {
6381 widget = XtParent (widget);
6382 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6383 }
6384 }
6385 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6386
6387 if (f != 0)
6388 {
6389 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6390 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6391 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6392 his Emacs hang.
6393
6394 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6395 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6396 status_return even if the input is too long to
6397 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6398 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6399 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6400 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6401 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6402 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6403 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6404 int modifiers;
6405 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6406 Lisp_Object c;
6407
6408 #ifdef USE_GTK
6409 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6410 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6411 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6412 (see above). */
6413 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6414 #endif
6415
6416 event.xkey.state
6417 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6418 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6419 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6420
6421 /* This will have to go some day... */
6422
6423 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6424 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6425 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6426 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6427 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6428 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6429 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6430
6431 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6432 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6433 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6434 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6435 not it is combined with Meta. */
6436 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6437 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6438
6439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6440 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6441 {
6442 Status status_return;
6443
6444 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6445 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6446 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6447 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6448 &status_return);
6449 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6450 {
6451 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6452 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6453 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6454 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6455 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6456 &status_return);
6457 }
6458 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6459 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6460 break;
6461 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6462 {
6463 keysym = NoSymbol;
6464 modifiers = 0;
6465 }
6466 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6467 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6468 abort ();
6469 }
6470 else
6471 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6472 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6473 &compose_status);
6474 #else
6475 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6476 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6477 &compose_status);
6478 #endif
6479
6480 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6481 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6482 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6483 break;
6484
6485 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6486 orig_keysym = keysym;
6487
6488 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6489 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6490 inev.ie.modifiers
6491 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6492 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6493
6494 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6495 translations to characters. */
6496 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6497 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6498 {
6499 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6500 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6501 goto done_keysym;
6502 }
6503
6504 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6505 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6506 {
6507 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6508 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6509 else
6510 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6511 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6512 goto done_keysym;
6513 }
6514
6515 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6516 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6517 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6518 Vx_keysym_table,
6519 Qnil),
6520 NATNUMP (c)))
6521 {
6522 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6523 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6524 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6525 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6526 goto done_keysym;
6527 }
6528
6529 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6530 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6531 || keysym == XK_Delete
6532 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6533 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6534 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6535 #endif
6536 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6537 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6538 #ifdef HPUX
6539 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6540 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6541 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6542 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6543 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6544 #endif
6545 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6546 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6547 #endif
6548 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6549 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6550 #endif
6551 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6552 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6553 #endif
6554 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6555 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6556 #endif
6557 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6558 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6559 #endif
6560 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6561 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6562 #endif
6563 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6564 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6565 #endif
6566 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6567 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6568 #endif
6569 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6570 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6571 #endif
6572 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6573 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6574 #endif
6575 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6576 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6577 #endif
6578 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6579 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6580 #endif
6581 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6582 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6583 #endif
6584 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6585 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6586 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6587 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6588 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6589 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6590 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6591 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6592 don't have real modifiers but
6593 should be treated similarly to
6594 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6595 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6596 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6597 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6598 #endif
6599 ))
6600 {
6601 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6602 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6603 key. */
6604 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6605 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6606 goto done_keysym;
6607 }
6608
6609 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6610 ptrdiff_t i;
6611 int nchars, len;
6612
6613 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6614 {
6615 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6616 nchars++;
6617 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6618 }
6619
6620 if (nchars < nbytes)
6621 {
6622 /* Decode the input data. */
6623
6624 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6625 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6626 we used just above and the locale. */
6627 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6628 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6629 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6630 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6631 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6632 gives us composition information. */
6633 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6634
6635 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6636 nbytes);
6637 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6638 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6639 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6640 nbytes = coding.produced;
6641 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6642 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6643 }
6644
6645 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6646 character events. */
6647 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6648 {
6649 int ch;
6650 if (nchars == nbytes)
6651 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6652 else
6653 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6654 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6655 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6656 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6657 inev.ie.code = ch;
6658 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6659 }
6660
6661 count += nchars;
6662
6663 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6664
6665 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6666 break;
6667 }
6668 }
6669 done_keysym:
6670 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6671 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6672 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6673 client. */
6674 break;
6675 #else
6676 goto OTHER;
6677 #endif
6678
6679 case KeyRelease:
6680 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6681 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6682 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6683 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6684 client. */
6685 break;
6686 #else
6687 goto OTHER;
6688 #endif
6689
6690 case EnterNotify:
6691 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6692 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6693
6694 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6695
6696 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6697 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6698
6699 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6700 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6701 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6702 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6703 #ifdef USE_GTK
6704 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6705 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6706 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6707 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6708 #endif
6709 goto OTHER;
6710
6711 case FocusIn:
6712 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6713 goto OTHER;
6714
6715 case LeaveNotify:
6716 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6717 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6718
6719 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6720 if (f)
6721 {
6722 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6723 {
6724 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6725 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6726 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6727 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6728 }
6729
6730 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6731 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6732 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6733 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6734 if (any_help_event_p)
6735 do_help = -1;
6736 }
6737 #ifdef USE_GTK
6738 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6739 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6740 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6741 #endif
6742 goto OTHER;
6743
6744 case FocusOut:
6745 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6746 goto OTHER;
6747
6748 case MotionNotify:
6749 {
6750 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6751 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6752 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6753
6754 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6755 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6756 f = last_mouse_frame;
6757 else
6758 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6759
6760 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6761 {
6762 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6763 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6764 }
6765
6766 #ifdef USE_GTK
6767 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6768 f = 0;
6769 #endif
6770 if (f)
6771 {
6772
6773 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6774 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6775 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6776 {
6777 Lisp_Object window;
6778
6779 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6780 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6781 0, 0);
6782
6783 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6784 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6785 will be selected only when it is active. */
6786 if (WINDOWP (window)
6787 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6788 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6789 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6790 create event iff we don't leave the
6791 selected frame. */
6792 && (focus_follows_mouse
6793 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6794 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6795 {
6796 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6797 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6798 }
6799
6800 last_window=window;
6801 }
6802 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6803 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6804 }
6805 else
6806 {
6807 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6808 struct scroll_bar *bar
6809 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6810 event.xmotion.window);
6811
6812 if (bar)
6813 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6814 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6815
6816 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6817 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6818 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6819 }
6820
6821 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6822 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6823 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6824 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6825 do_help = 1;
6826 goto OTHER;
6827 }
6828
6829 case ConfigureNotify:
6830 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6831 #ifdef USE_GTK
6832 if (!f
6833 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6834 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6835 {
6836 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6837 event.xconfigure.height);
6838 f = 0;
6839 }
6840 #endif
6841 if (f)
6842 {
6843 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6844 #ifndef USE_GTK
6845 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6846 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6847
6848 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6849 is called by the code that handles resizing
6850 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6851
6852 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6853 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6854 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6855 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6856 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6857 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6858 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6859 {
6860 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6861 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6862 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6863 }
6864
6865 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6866 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6867 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6868 #endif
6869
6870 #ifdef USE_GTK
6871 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6872 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6873 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6874 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6875 #endif
6876 {
6877 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6878 }
6879
6880 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6881 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6882 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6883 #endif
6884
6885 }
6886 goto OTHER;
6887
6888 case ButtonRelease:
6889 case ButtonPress:
6890 {
6891 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6892 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6893 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6894
6895 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6896 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6897 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6898
6899 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6900 && last_mouse_frame
6901 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6902 f = last_mouse_frame;
6903 else
6904 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6905
6906 #ifdef USE_GTK
6907 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6908 f = 0;
6909 #endif
6910 if (f)
6911 {
6912 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6913 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6914 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6915 {
6916 Lisp_Object window;
6917 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6918 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6919
6920 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6921 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6922
6923 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6924 {
6925 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6926 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6927 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6928 event.xbutton.state));
6929 }
6930 }
6931
6932 if (!tool_bar_p)
6933 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6934 if (! popup_activated ())
6935 #endif
6936 {
6937 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6938 {
6939 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6940 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6941 {
6942 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6943 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6944 }
6945 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6946 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6947 }
6948 else
6949 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6950 }
6951 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6952 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6953 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6954 }
6955 else
6956 {
6957 struct scroll_bar *bar
6958 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6959 event.xbutton.window);
6960
6961 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6962 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6963 scroll bars. */
6964 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6965 {
6966 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6967 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6968 }
6969 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6970 if (bar)
6971 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6972 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6973 }
6974
6975 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6976 {
6977 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6978 last_mouse_frame = f;
6979
6980 if (!tool_bar_p)
6981 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6982 }
6983 else
6984 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6985
6986 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6987 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6988 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6989 if (f != 0)
6990 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6991
6992 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6993 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6994 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6995 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6996 Instead, save it away
6997 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6998 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6999 if (! popup_activated ()
7000 #ifdef USE_GTK
7001 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7002 && event.xbutton.button < 3
7003 #endif
7004 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
7005 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7006 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7007 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7008 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7009 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7010 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7011 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7012 {
7013 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7014 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7015 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7016 }
7017 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7018 {
7019 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7020 goto OTHER;
7021 }
7022 else
7023 goto OTHER;
7024 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7025 }
7026 break;
7027
7028 case CirculateNotify:
7029 goto OTHER;
7030
7031 case CirculateRequest:
7032 goto OTHER;
7033
7034 case VisibilityNotify:
7035 goto OTHER;
7036
7037 case MappingNotify:
7038 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7039 local cache. */
7040 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7041 {
7042 case MappingModifier:
7043 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7044 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7045 case MappingKeyboard:
7046 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7047 }
7048 goto OTHER;
7049
7050 case DestroyNotify:
7051 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7052 break;
7053
7054 default:
7055 OTHER:
7056 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7057 BLOCK_INPUT;
7058 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7059 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7061 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7062 break;
7063 }
7064
7065 done:
7066 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7067 {
7068 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7069 count++;
7070 }
7071
7072 if (do_help
7073 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7074 {
7075 Lisp_Object frame;
7076
7077 if (f)
7078 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7079 else
7080 frame = Qnil;
7081
7082 if (do_help > 0)
7083 {
7084 any_help_event_p = 1;
7085 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7086 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7087 }
7088 else
7089 {
7090 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7091 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7092 }
7093 count++;
7094 }
7095
7096 SAFE_FREE ();
7097 *eventptr = event;
7098 return count;
7099 }
7100
7101 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7102
7103 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7104 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7105 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7106
7107 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7108 int
7109 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7110 {
7111 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7112 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7113
7114 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7115
7116 if (dpyinfo)
7117 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7118
7119 return finish;
7120 }
7121 #endif
7122
7123
7124 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7125 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7126 not defined.
7127 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7128
7129 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7130 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7131 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7132 C chars).
7133
7134 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7135
7136 static int
7137 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7138 {
7139 int count = 0;
7140 int event_found = 0;
7141
7142 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7143 {
7144 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7145 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7146 pending_signals = 1;
7147 #endif
7148 return -1;
7149 }
7150
7151 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7152 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7153 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7154 #endif
7155 BLOCK_INPUT;
7156
7157 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7158 input_signal_count++;
7159
7160 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7161 ++handling_signal;
7162 #endif
7163
7164 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7165 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7166 {
7167 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7168 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7169 }
7170
7171 #ifndef USE_GTK
7172 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7173 {
7174 int finish;
7175 XEvent event;
7176
7177 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7178
7179 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7180 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7181 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7182 continue;
7183 #endif
7184 event_found = 1;
7185
7186 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7187 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7188
7189 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7190 goto out;
7191 }
7192
7193 out:;
7194
7195 #else /* USE_GTK */
7196
7197 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7198 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7199 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7200 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7201
7202 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7203 from all displays. */
7204
7205 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7206 {
7207 current_count = count;
7208 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7209
7210 gtk_main_iteration ();
7211
7212 count = current_count;
7213 current_count = -1;
7214 current_hold_quit = 0;
7215
7216 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7217 break;
7218 }
7219 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7220
7221 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7222 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7223 if (! event_found)
7224 {
7225 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7226 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7227 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7228 x_noop_count++;
7229 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7230 {
7231 x_noop_count=0;
7232
7233 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7234 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7235
7236 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7237
7238 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7239 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7240 }
7241 }
7242
7243 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7244 raise it now. */
7245 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7246 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7247 {
7248 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7249 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7250 }
7251
7252 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7253 --handling_signal;
7254 #endif
7255 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7256
7257 return count;
7258 }
7259
7260
7261
7262 \f
7263 /***********************************************************************
7264 Text Cursor
7265 ***********************************************************************/
7266
7267 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7268 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7269
7270 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7271 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7272 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7273
7274 static void
7275 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7276 {
7277 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7278 XRectangle clip_rect;
7279 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7280
7281 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7282
7283 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7284 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7285 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7286 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7287 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7288
7289 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7290 }
7291
7292
7293 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7294
7295 static void
7296 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7297 {
7298 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7299 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7300 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7301 int x, y, wd, h;
7302 XGCValues xgcv;
7303 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7304 GC gc;
7305
7306 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7307 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7308 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7309 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7310 return;
7311
7312 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7313 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7314 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7315
7316 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7317 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7318 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7319 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7320 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7321 else
7322 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7323 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7324 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7325
7326 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7327 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7328 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7329 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7330 }
7331
7332
7333 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7334
7335 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7336 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7337 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7338 --gerd. */
7339
7340 static void
7341 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7342 {
7343 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7344 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7345
7346 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7347 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7348 and mini-buffer. */
7349 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7350 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7351 return;
7352
7353 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7354 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7355 the bar might not be in the window. */
7356 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7357 {
7358 struct glyph_row *r;
7359 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7360 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7361 }
7362 else
7363 {
7364 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7365 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7366 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7367 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7368 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7369 XGCValues xgcv;
7370
7371 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7372 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7373 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7374 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7375 that the glyph is legible. */
7376 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7377 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7378 else
7379 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7380 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7381
7382 if (gc)
7383 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7384 else
7385 {
7386 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7387 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7388 }
7389
7390 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7391
7392 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7393 {
7394 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7395
7396 if (width < 0)
7397 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7398 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7399
7400 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7401
7402 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7403 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7404 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7405 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7406
7407 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7408 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7409 width, row->height);
7410 }
7411 else
7412 {
7413 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7414
7415 if (width < 0)
7416 width = row->height;
7417
7418 width = min (row->height, width);
7419
7420 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7421 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7422
7423 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7424 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7425 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7426 row->height - width),
7427 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7428 }
7429
7430 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7431 }
7432 }
7433
7434
7435 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7436
7437 static void
7438 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7439 {
7440 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7441 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7442 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7443 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7444 }
7445
7446
7447 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7448
7449 static void
7450 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7451 {
7452 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7453 x, y, width, height, False);
7454 #ifdef USE_GTK
7455 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7456 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7457 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7458 #endif
7459 }
7460
7461
7462 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7463
7464 static void
7465 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7466 {
7467 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7468
7469 if (on_p)
7470 {
7471 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7472 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7473
7474 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7475 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7476 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7477 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7478 {
7479 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7480 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7481 }
7482 else
7483 {
7484 switch (cursor_type)
7485 {
7486 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7487 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7488 break;
7489
7490 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7491 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7492 break;
7493
7494 case BAR_CURSOR:
7495 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7496 break;
7497
7498 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7499 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7500 break;
7501
7502 case NO_CURSOR:
7503 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7504 break;
7505
7506 default:
7507 abort ();
7508 }
7509 }
7510
7511 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7512 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7513 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7514 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7515 #endif
7516 }
7517
7518 #ifndef XFlush
7519 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7520 #endif
7521 }
7522
7523 \f
7524 /* Icons. */
7525
7526 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7527
7528 int
7529 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7530 {
7531 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7532
7533 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7534 return 1;
7535
7536 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7537 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7538 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7539 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7540
7541 if (STRINGP (file))
7542 {
7543 #ifdef USE_GTK
7544 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7545 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7546 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7547 return 0;
7548 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7549 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7550 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7551 }
7552 else
7553 {
7554 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7555 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7556 {
7557 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7558
7559 #ifdef USE_GTK
7560
7561 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7562 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7563 return 0;
7564
7565 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7566
7567 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7568 if (rc != -1)
7569 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7570
7571 #endif
7572
7573 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7574 if (rc == -1)
7575 {
7576 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7577 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7578 if (rc == -1)
7579 return 1;
7580
7581 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7582 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7583 }
7584 }
7585
7586 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7587 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7588 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7589 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7590 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7591
7592 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7593 }
7594
7595 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7596 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7597
7598 return 0;
7599 }
7600
7601
7602 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7603 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7604
7605 int
7606 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7607 {
7608 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7609 return 1;
7610
7611 {
7612 XTextProperty text;
7613 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7614 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7615 text.format = 8;
7616 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7617 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7618 }
7619
7620 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7621 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7622 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7623 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7624
7625 return 0;
7626 }
7627 \f
7628 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7629
7630 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7631 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7632
7633 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7634 be called from a signal handler.
7635 */
7636
7637 struct x_error_message_stack {
7638 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7639 Display *dpy;
7640 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7641 };
7642 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7643
7644 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7645 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7646 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7647
7648 static void
7649 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7650 {
7651 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7652 x_error_message->string,
7653 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7654 }
7655
7656 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7657 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7658 operating on.
7659
7660 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7661 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7662 stored in *x_error_message.
7663
7664 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7665 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7666
7667 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7668
7669 void
7670 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7671 {
7672 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7673
7674 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7675 XSync (dpy, False);
7676
7677 data->dpy = dpy;
7678 data->string[0] = 0;
7679 data->prev = x_error_message;
7680 x_error_message = data;
7681 }
7682
7683 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7684 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7685
7686 void
7687 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7688 {
7689 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7690
7691 BLOCK_INPUT;
7692
7693 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7694 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7695 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7696 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7697
7698 tmp = x_error_message;
7699 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7700 xfree (tmp);
7701 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7702 }
7703
7704 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7705 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7706 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7707
7708 void
7709 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7710 {
7711 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7712 XSync (dpy, False);
7713
7714 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7715 {
7716 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7717 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7718 x_uncatch_errors ();
7719 error (format, string);
7720 }
7721 }
7722
7723 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7724 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7725
7726 int
7727 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7728 {
7729 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7730 XSync (dpy, False);
7731
7732 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7733 }
7734
7735 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7736
7737 void
7738 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7739 {
7740 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7741 }
7742
7743 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7744 * idea. --lorentey */
7745 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7746
7747 void
7748 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7749 {
7750 while (x_error_message)
7751 x_uncatch_errors ();
7752 }
7753 #endif
7754
7755 #if 0
7756 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7757 x_trace_wire (void)
7758 {
7759 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7760 }
7761 #endif /* ! 0 */
7762
7763 \f
7764 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7765 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7766 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7767 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7768 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7769
7770 static void
7771 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7772 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7773 {
7774 #ifdef USG
7775 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7776 must reestablish each time */
7777 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7778 #endif /* USG */
7779 }
7780
7781 \f
7782 /************************************************************************
7783 Handling X errors
7784 ************************************************************************/
7785
7786 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7787
7788 static char *error_msg;
7789
7790 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7791 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7792
7793 static void
7794 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7795 {
7796 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7797 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7798 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7799
7800 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7801 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7802 handling_signal = 0;
7803
7804 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7805 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7806
7807 if (dpyinfo)
7808 {
7809 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7810 frame on it. */
7811 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7812 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7813 }
7814
7815 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7816 that are on the dead display. */
7817 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7818 {
7819 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7820 minibuf_frame
7821 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7822 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7823 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7824 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7825 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7826 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7827 }
7828
7829 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7830 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7831 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7832 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7833 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7834 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7835 {
7836 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7837 trying to find a replacement. */
7838 KSET (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame, Qt);
7839 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7840 }
7841
7842 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7843 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7844 if (dpyinfo)
7845 {
7846 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7847 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7848 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7849 #ifdef USE_GTK
7850 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7851 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7852 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7853 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7854 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7855 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7856 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7857 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7858 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7859 error_msg);
7860 abort ();
7861 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7862
7863 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7864 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7865
7866 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7867 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7868 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7869 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7870 abort ();
7871
7872 {
7873 Lisp_Object tmp;
7874 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7875 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7876 }
7877 }
7878
7879 if (terminal_list == 0)
7880 {
7881 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7882 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7883 /* NOTREACHED */
7884 }
7885
7886 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7887 #ifdef SIGIO
7888 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7889 #endif
7890 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7891 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7892
7893 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7894 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7895
7896 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7897 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7898
7899 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7900 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7901 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7902 error ("%s", error_msg);
7903 }
7904
7905 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7906 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7907 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7908
7909 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7910 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7911
7912 static int
7913 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7914 {
7915 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7916 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7917 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7918 && event->minor_code == 0)
7919 {
7920 return 0;
7921 }
7922 #endif
7923
7924 if (x_error_message)
7925 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7926 else
7927 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7928 return 0;
7929 }
7930
7931 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7932 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7933 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7934
7935 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7936
7937 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7938 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7939
7940 static void NO_INLINE
7941 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7942 {
7943 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7944
7945 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7946 or colors that are not defined. */
7947
7948 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7949 return;
7950
7951 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7952 original error handler. */
7953
7954 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7955 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7956 buf, event->request_code);
7957 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7958 }
7959
7960
7961 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7962 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7963 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7964
7965 static int
7966 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7967 {
7968 char buf[256];
7969
7970 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7971 DisplayString (display));
7972 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7973 return 0;
7974 }
7975 \f
7976 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7977
7978 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7979 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7980 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7981 FONT-OBJECT. */
7982
7983 Lisp_Object
7984 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7985 {
7986 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7987
7988 if (fontset < 0)
7989 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7990 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7991 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7992 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7993 do. */
7994 return font_object;
7995
7996 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7997 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7998 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7999 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
8000 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8001
8002 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8003
8004 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8005 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8006 {
8007 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8008 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8009 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8010 }
8011 else
8012 {
8013 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8014 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8015 }
8016
8017 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8018 {
8019 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8020 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8021 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8022 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8023 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8024 }
8025
8026 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8027 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8028 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8029 {
8030 BLOCK_INPUT;
8031 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8032 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8033 }
8034 #endif
8035
8036 return font_object;
8037 }
8038
8039 \f
8040 /***********************************************************************
8041 X Input Methods
8042 ***********************************************************************/
8043
8044 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8045
8046 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8047
8048 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8049 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8050 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8051
8052 static void
8053 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8054 {
8055 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8056 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8057
8058 BLOCK_INPUT;
8059
8060 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8061 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8062 {
8063 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8064 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8065 {
8066 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8067 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8068 }
8069 }
8070
8071 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8072 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8073 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8074 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8075 }
8076
8077 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8078
8079 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8080 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8081 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8082 #endif
8083
8084 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8085 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8086
8087 static void
8088 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8089 {
8090 XIM xim;
8091
8092 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8093 if (use_xim)
8094 {
8095 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8096 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8097 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8098 emacs_class);
8099 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8100
8101 if (xim)
8102 {
8103 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8104 XIMCallback destroy;
8105 #endif
8106
8107 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8108 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8109
8110 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8111 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8112 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8113 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8114 #endif
8115 }
8116 }
8117
8118 else
8119 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8120 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8121 }
8122
8123
8124 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8125
8126 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8127 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8128 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8129 when the callback was registered. */
8130
8131 static void
8132 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8133 {
8134 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8135 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8136
8137 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8138 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8139 return;
8140
8141 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8142
8143 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8144 as they have no XIC. */
8145 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8146 {
8147 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8148
8149 BLOCK_INPUT;
8150 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8151 {
8152 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8153
8154 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8155 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8156 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8157 {
8158 create_frame_xic (f);
8159 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8160 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8161 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8162 {
8163 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8164 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8165 }
8166 }
8167 }
8168
8169 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8170 }
8171 }
8172
8173 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8174
8175
8176 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8177 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8178 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8179 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8180
8181 static void
8182 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8183 {
8184 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8185 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8186 if (use_xim)
8187 {
8188 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8189 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8190 ptrdiff_t len;
8191
8192 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8193 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8194 len = strlen (resource_name);
8195 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8196 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8197 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8198 resource_name, emacs_class,
8199 xim_instantiate_callback,
8200 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8201 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8202 least, hence the configure test. */
8203 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8204 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8205 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8206 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8207 }
8208 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8209 }
8210
8211
8212 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8213
8214 static void
8215 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8216 {
8217 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8218 if (use_xim)
8219 {
8220 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8221 if (dpyinfo->display)
8222 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8223 NULL, emacs_class,
8224 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8225 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8226 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8227 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8228 if (dpyinfo->display)
8229 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8230 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8231 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8232 }
8233 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8234 }
8235
8236 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8237
8238
8239 \f
8240 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8241 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8242
8243 static void
8244 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8245 {
8246 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8247
8248 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8249 is already for the top-left corner. */
8250 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8251 return;
8252
8253 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8254 position that fits on the screen. */
8255 if (flags & XNegative)
8256 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8257 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8258
8259 {
8260 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8261
8262 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8263 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8264 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8265
8266 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8267 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8268 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8269 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8270 is right, though.
8271
8272 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8273 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8274
8275 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8276 #endif
8277
8278 if (flags & YNegative)
8279 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8280 - height + f->top_pos;
8281 }
8282
8283 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8284 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8285 so the flags should correspond. */
8286 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8287 }
8288
8289 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8290 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8291 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8292 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8293 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8294
8295 void
8296 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8297 {
8298 int modified_top, modified_left;
8299
8300 if (change_gravity > 0)
8301 {
8302 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8303 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8304
8305 f->top_pos = yoff;
8306 f->left_pos = xoff;
8307 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8308 if (xoff < 0)
8309 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8310 if (yoff < 0)
8311 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8312 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8313 }
8314 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8315
8316 BLOCK_INPUT;
8317 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8318
8319 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8320 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8321
8322 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8323 {
8324 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8325 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8326 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8327 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8328 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8329 }
8330
8331 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8332 modified_left, modified_top);
8333
8334 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8335 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8336 ? 1 : 0);
8337
8338 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8339 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8340 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8341 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8342 of the frame.
8343
8344 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8345 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8346 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8347
8348 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8349 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8350 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8351 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8352 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8353 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8354
8355 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8356 }
8357
8358 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8359 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8360 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8361 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8362 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8363
8364 static int
8365 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8366 {
8367 Atom actual_type;
8368 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8369 int i, rc, actual_format;
8370 Window wmcheck_window;
8371 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8372 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8373 long max_len = 65536;
8374 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8375 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8376 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8377
8378 BLOCK_INPUT;
8379
8380 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8381 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8382 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8383 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8384 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8385 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8386
8387 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8388 {
8389 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8390 x_uncatch_errors ();
8391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8392 return 0;
8393 }
8394
8395 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8396 XFree (tmp_data);
8397
8398 /* Check if window exists. */
8399 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8400 x_sync (f);
8401 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8402 {
8403 x_uncatch_errors ();
8404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8405 return 0;
8406 }
8407
8408 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8409 {
8410 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8411 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8412 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8413 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8414 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8415 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8416
8417 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8418 tmp_data = NULL;
8419 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8420 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8421 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8422 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8423 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8424
8425 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8426 {
8427 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8428 x_uncatch_errors ();
8429 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8430 return 0;
8431 }
8432
8433 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8434 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8435 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8436 }
8437
8438 rc = 0;
8439
8440 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8441 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8442
8443 x_uncatch_errors ();
8444 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8445
8446 return rc;
8447 }
8448
8449 static void
8450 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8451 {
8452 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8453
8454 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8455 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8456 make_number (32),
8457 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8458 Fcons
8459 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8460 Fcons
8461 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8462 value != 0
8463 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8464 : Qnil)));
8465 }
8466
8467 void
8468 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8469 {
8470 Lisp_Object frame;
8471 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8472
8473 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8474
8475 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8476 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8477 }
8478
8479 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8480 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8481 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8482
8483 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8484
8485 static int
8486 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8487 Window window,
8488 int *size_state,
8489 int *sticky)
8490 {
8491 Atom actual_type;
8492 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8493 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8494 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8495 long max_len = 65536;
8496 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8497 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8498 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8499
8500 *sticky = 0;
8501 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8502
8503 BLOCK_INPUT;
8504 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8505 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8506 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8507 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8508 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8509
8510 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8511 {
8512 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8513 x_uncatch_errors ();
8514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8515 return ! f->iconified;
8516 }
8517
8518 x_uncatch_errors ();
8519
8520 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8521 {
8522 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8523 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8524 {
8525 is_hidden = 1;
8526 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8527 }
8528 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8529 {
8530 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8531 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8532 else
8533 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8534 }
8535 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8536 {
8537 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8538 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8539 else
8540 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8541 }
8542 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8543 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8544 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8545 *sticky = 1;
8546 }
8547
8548 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8550 return ! is_hidden;
8551 }
8552
8553 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8554
8555 static int
8556 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8557 {
8558 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8559 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8560 int cur, dummy;
8561
8562 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8563
8564 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8565 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8566 if (!have_net_atom)
8567 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8568
8569 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8570 {
8571 Lisp_Object frame;
8572
8573 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8574
8575 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8576 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8577 are sent at once. */
8578 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8579 {
8580 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8581 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8582 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8583 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8584 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8585 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8586 break;
8587 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8588 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8589 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8590 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8591 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8592 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8593 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8594 break;
8595 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8596 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8597 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8598 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8599 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8600 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8601 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8602 break;
8603 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8604 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8605 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8606 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8607 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8608 break;
8609 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8610 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8611 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8612 else
8613 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8614 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8615 }
8616
8617 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8618
8619 }
8620
8621 return have_net_atom;
8622 }
8623
8624 static void
8625 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8626 {
8627 if (f->async_visible)
8628 {
8629 BLOCK_INPUT;
8630 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8631 x_sync (f);
8632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8633 }
8634 }
8635
8636
8637 static int
8638 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8639 {
8640 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8641 Lisp_Object lval;
8642 int sticky = 0;
8643 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8644
8645 lval = Qnil;
8646 switch (value)
8647 {
8648 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8649 lval = Qfullwidth;
8650 break;
8651 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8652 lval = Qfullheight;
8653 break;
8654 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8655 lval = Qfullboth;
8656 break;
8657 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8658 lval = Qmaximized;
8659 break;
8660 }
8661
8662 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8663 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8664
8665 return not_hidden;
8666 }
8667
8668 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8669 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8670 static void
8671 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8672 {
8673 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8674 return;
8675
8676 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8677 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8678
8679 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8680 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8681 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8682
8683 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8684 {
8685 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8686 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8687
8688 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8689 {
8690 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8691 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8692 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8693 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8694 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8695 break;
8696 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8697 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8698 break;
8699 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8700 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8701 }
8702
8703 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8704 width, height);
8705 }
8706 }
8707
8708 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8709 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8710 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8711 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8712 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8713 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8714 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8715
8716 static void
8717 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8718 {
8719 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8720
8721 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8722 window manager window around the frame. */
8723
8724 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8725
8726 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8727 {
8728 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8729
8730 int adjusted_left;
8731 int adjusted_top;
8732
8733 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8734 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8735 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8736
8737 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8738
8739 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8740 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8741
8742 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8743 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8744
8745 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8746 }
8747 else
8748 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8749 frame's position. */
8750
8751 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8752 }
8753
8754
8755 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8756 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8757 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8758 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8759 of an exact comparison. */
8760
8761 static void
8762 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8763 {
8764 int count = 0;
8765
8766 while (count++ < 50)
8767 {
8768 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8769
8770 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8771 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8772 loop. */
8773
8774 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8775 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8776
8777 if (fuzzy)
8778 {
8779 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8780 pixels. */
8781
8782 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8783 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8784 return;
8785 }
8786 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8787 return;
8788 }
8789
8790 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8791 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8792
8793 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8794 }
8795
8796
8797 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8798 void
8799 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8800 {
8801 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8802
8803 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8804 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8805 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8806
8807 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8808 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8809
8810 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8811 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8812 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8813 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8814
8815 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8816 {
8817 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8818 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8819 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8820 BLOCK_INPUT;
8821 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8822
8823 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8824 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8825
8826 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8827 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8828 break;
8829
8830 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8831 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8832 break; /* Timeout */
8833 }
8834 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8835 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8836 }
8837
8838
8839 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8840 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8841 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8842 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8843
8844 static void
8845 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8846 {
8847 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8848
8849 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8850 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8851 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8852 ? 0
8853 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8854
8855 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8856
8857 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8858 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8859 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8860 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8861
8862 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8863 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8864 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8865 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8866
8867
8868 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8869 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8870 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8871 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8872 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8873
8874 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8875 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8876 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8877 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8878
8879 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8880 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8881 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8882 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8883 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8884
8885 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8886 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8887
8888 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8889 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8890 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8891 if (f->async_visible)
8892 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8893 else
8894 {
8895 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8896 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8897 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8898 x_sync (f);
8899 }
8900 }
8901
8902
8903 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8904 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8905 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8906 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8907
8908 void
8909 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8910 {
8911 BLOCK_INPUT;
8912
8913 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8914 {
8915 int r, c;
8916
8917 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8918 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8919 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8920 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8921 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8922 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8923 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8924 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8925 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8926 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8927 is however. */
8928 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8929 #endif
8930 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8931 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8932 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8933 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8934 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8935 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8936 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8937 }
8938
8939 #ifdef USE_GTK
8940 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8941 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8942 else
8943 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8944 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8945
8946 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8947
8948 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8949
8950 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8951 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8952
8953 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8954 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8955 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8956 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8957 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8958
8959 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8960 }
8961 \f
8962 /* Mouse warping. */
8963
8964 void
8965 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8966 {
8967 int pix_x, pix_y;
8968
8969 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8970 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8971
8972 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8973 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8974
8975 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8976 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8977
8978 BLOCK_INPUT;
8979
8980 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8981 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8982 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8983 }
8984
8985 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8986
8987 void
8988 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8989 {
8990 BLOCK_INPUT;
8991
8992 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8993 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8994 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8995 }
8996 \f
8997 /* Raise frame F. */
8998
8999 void
9000 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
9001 {
9002 BLOCK_INPUT;
9003 if (f->async_visible)
9004 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9005
9006 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9007 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9008 }
9009
9010 /* Lower frame F. */
9011
9012 static void
9013 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9014 {
9015 if (f->async_visible)
9016 {
9017 BLOCK_INPUT;
9018 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9019 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9020 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9021 }
9022 }
9023
9024 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9025
9026 void
9027 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9028 {
9029 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9030 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9031 if (f->async_visible)
9032 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9033 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9034 }
9035
9036 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9037
9038 void
9039 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9040 {
9041 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9042 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9043
9044 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9045 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9046 {
9047 Lisp_Object frame;
9048 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9049 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9050 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9051 make_number (32),
9052 Fcons (make_number (1),
9053 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9054 Qnil)));
9055 }
9056 }
9057
9058 static void
9059 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9060 {
9061 if (raise_flag)
9062 x_raise_frame (f);
9063 else
9064 x_lower_frame (f);
9065 }
9066 \f
9067 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9068
9069 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9070
9071 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9072
9073 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9074
9075 static void
9076 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9077 {
9078 unsigned long data[2];
9079 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9080
9081 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9082 data[1] = flags;
9083
9084 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9085 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9086 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9087 }
9088 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9089
9090 static void
9091 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9092 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9093 {
9094 XEvent event;
9095
9096 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9097 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9098 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9099 event.xclient.format = 32;
9100 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9101 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9102 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9103 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9104 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9105
9106 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9107 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9108 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9109 }
9110 \f
9111 /* Change of visibility. */
9112
9113 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9114 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9115 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9116 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9117 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9118 finishes with it. */
9119
9120 void
9121 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9122 {
9123 Lisp_Object type;
9124 int original_top, original_left;
9125 int retry_count = 2;
9126
9127 retry:
9128
9129 BLOCK_INPUT;
9130
9131 type = x_icon_type (f);
9132 if (!NILP (type))
9133 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9134
9135 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9136 {
9137 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9138 call x_set_offset a second time
9139 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9140 before the window gets really visible. */
9141 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9142 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9143 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9144 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9145
9146 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9147
9148 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9149 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9150 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9151 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9152 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9153 else
9154 {
9155 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9156 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9157 }
9158 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9159 #ifdef USE_GTK
9160 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9161 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9162 #else
9163 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9164 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9165 else
9166 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9167 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9168 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9169 }
9170
9171 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9172
9173 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9174 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9175 so that incoming events are handled. */
9176 {
9177 Lisp_Object frame;
9178 int count;
9179 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9180 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9181 will set it when they are handled. */
9182 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9183
9184 original_left = f->left_pos;
9185 original_top = f->top_pos;
9186
9187 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9188 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9189
9190 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9191
9192 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9193 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9194 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9195 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9196
9197 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9198 because the window manager may choose the position
9199 and we don't want to override it. */
9200
9201 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9202 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9203 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9204 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9205 && previously_visible)
9206 {
9207 Drawable rootw;
9208 int x, y;
9209 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9210
9211 BLOCK_INPUT;
9212
9213 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9214 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9215 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9216 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9217 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9218 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9219 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9220 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9221 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9222
9223 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9224 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9225 original_left, original_top);
9226
9227 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9228 }
9229
9230 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9231
9232 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9233 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9234 MapNotify at all.. */
9235 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9236 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9237 {
9238 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9239 x_sync (f);
9240
9241 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9242 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9243 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9244 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9245 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9246 probably a bug. */
9247 if (input_polling_used ())
9248 {
9249 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9250 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9251 handler reset it. */
9252 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9253 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9254 poll_for_input_1 ();
9255 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9256 }
9257
9258 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9259 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9260 }
9261
9262 /* 2000-09-28: In
9263
9264 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9265 (iconify-frame f)
9266 (raise-frame f))
9267
9268 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9269 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9270 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9271 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9272
9273 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9274 goto retry;
9275 }
9276 }
9277
9278 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9279
9280 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9281
9282 void
9283 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9284 {
9285 Window window;
9286
9287 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9288 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9289
9290 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9291 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9292 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9293
9294 BLOCK_INPUT;
9295
9296 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9297 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9298 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9299 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9300 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9301 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9302
9303 #ifdef USE_GTK
9304 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9305 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9306 else
9307 #else
9308 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9309 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9310 else
9311 #endif
9312 {
9313
9314 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9315 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9316 {
9317 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9318 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9319 }
9320 }
9321
9322 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9323 just by the event that we get from the server.
9324 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9325 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9326 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9327 f->visible = 0;
9328 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9329 f->async_visible = 0;
9330 f->async_iconified = 0;
9331
9332 x_sync (f);
9333
9334 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9335 }
9336
9337 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9338
9339 void
9340 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9341 {
9342 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9343 int result;
9344 #endif
9345 Lisp_Object type;
9346
9347 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9348 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9349 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9350
9351 if (f->async_iconified)
9352 return;
9353
9354 BLOCK_INPUT;
9355
9356 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9357
9358 type = x_icon_type (f);
9359 if (!NILP (type))
9360 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9361
9362 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9363 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9364 {
9365 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9366 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9367
9368 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9369 f->iconified = 1;
9370 f->visible = 1;
9371 f->async_iconified = 1;
9372 f->async_visible = 0;
9373 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9374 return;
9375 }
9376 #endif
9377
9378 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9379
9380 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9381 {
9382 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9383 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9384 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9385 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9386 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9387 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9388 so we have to record it here. */
9389 f->iconified = 1;
9390 f->visible = 1;
9391 f->async_iconified = 1;
9392 f->async_visible = 0;
9393 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9394 return;
9395 }
9396
9397 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9398 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9399 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9400 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9401
9402 if (!result)
9403 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9404
9405 f->async_iconified = 1;
9406 f->async_visible = 0;
9407
9408
9409 BLOCK_INPUT;
9410 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9411 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9412 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9413
9414 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9415 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9416 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9417 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9418 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9419 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9420
9421 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9422 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9423
9424 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9425 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9426 {
9427 XEvent msg;
9428
9429 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9430 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9431 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9432 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9433 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9434
9435 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9436 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9437 False,
9438 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9439 &msg))
9440 {
9441 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9442 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9443 }
9444 }
9445
9446 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9447 IconicState. */
9448 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9449
9450 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9451 {
9452 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9453 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9454 }
9455
9456 f->async_iconified = 1;
9457 f->async_visible = 0;
9458
9459 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9460 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9461 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9462 }
9463
9464 \f
9465 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9466
9467 void
9468 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9469 {
9470 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9471 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9472 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9473 Lisp_Object bar;
9474 struct scroll_bar *b;
9475 #endif
9476
9477 BLOCK_INPUT;
9478
9479 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9480 commands to the X server. */
9481 if (dpyinfo->display)
9482 {
9483 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9484 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9485 face. */
9486 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9487 free_frame_faces (f);
9488
9489 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9490 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9491
9492 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9493 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9494 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9495 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9496 toolkit scroll bars. */
9497 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9498 {
9499 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9500 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9501 }
9502 #endif
9503
9504 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9505 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9506 free_frame_xic (f);
9507 #endif
9508
9509 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9510 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9511 {
9512 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9513 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9514 }
9515 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9516 we are using a toolkit. */
9517 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9518 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9519
9520 free_frame_menubar (f);
9521 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9522
9523 #ifdef USE_GTK
9524 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9525 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9526
9527 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9528 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9529 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9530
9531 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9532 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9533 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9534 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9535 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9536 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9537
9538 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9539 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9540 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9541 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9542 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9543 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9544 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9545 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9546 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9547 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9548 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9549 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9550 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9551 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9552 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9553
9554 x_free_gcs (f);
9555 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9556 }
9557
9558 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9559 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9560 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9561
9562 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9563 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9564 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9565 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9566 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9567 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9568
9569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9570 {
9571 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9572 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9573 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9574 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9575 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9576 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9577 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9578 }
9579
9580 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9581 }
9582
9583
9584 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9585
9586 static void
9587 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9588 {
9589 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9590
9591 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9592 commands to the X server. */
9593 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9594 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9595
9596 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9597 }
9598
9599 \f
9600 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9601
9602 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9603 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9604 that the window now has.
9605 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9606 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9607 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9608
9609 #ifndef USE_GTK
9610 void
9611 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9612 {
9613 XSizeHints size_hints;
9614 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9615
9616 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9617 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9618 {
9619 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9620 return;
9621 }
9622 #endif
9623
9624 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9625 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9626
9627 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9628 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9629
9630 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9631 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9632
9633 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9634 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9635 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9636 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9637 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9638 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9639
9640 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9641 {
9642 int base_width, base_height;
9643 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9644
9645 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9646 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9647
9648 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9649
9650 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9651 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9652 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9653 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9654 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9655
9656 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9657 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9658 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9659
9660 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9661 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9662 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9663 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9664 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9665 }
9666
9667 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9668 if (flags)
9669 {
9670 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9671 goto no_read;
9672 }
9673
9674 {
9675 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9676 long supplied_return;
9677 int value;
9678
9679 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9680 &supplied_return);
9681
9682 if (flags)
9683 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9684 else
9685 {
9686 if (value == 0)
9687 hints.flags = 0;
9688 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9689 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9690 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9691 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9692 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9693 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9694 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9695 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9696 }
9697 }
9698
9699 no_read:
9700
9701 #ifdef PWinGravity
9702 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9703 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9704
9705 if (user_position)
9706 {
9707 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9708 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9709 }
9710 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9711
9712 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9713 }
9714 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9715
9716 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9717
9718 static void
9719 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9720 {
9721 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9722 Arg al[1];
9723
9724 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9725 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9726 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9727 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9728
9729 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9730 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9731
9732 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9733 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9734 }
9735
9736 static void
9737 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9738 {
9739 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9740
9741 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9742 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9743 #endif
9744
9745 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9746 {
9747 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9748 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9749 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9750 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9751 }
9752 else
9753 {
9754 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9755 pixmap. */
9756 return;
9757 }
9758
9759
9760 #ifdef USE_GTK
9761 {
9762 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9763 return;
9764 }
9765
9766 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9767
9768 {
9769 Arg al[1];
9770 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9771 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9772 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9773 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9774 }
9775
9776 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9777
9778 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9779 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9780
9781 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9782 }
9783
9784 void
9785 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9786 {
9787 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9788
9789 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9790 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9791 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9792
9793 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9794 }
9795
9796 \f
9797 /***********************************************************************
9798 Fonts
9799 ***********************************************************************/
9800
9801 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9802
9803 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9804 font table. */
9805
9806 static void
9807 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9808 {
9809 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9810 if (font->driver->check)
9811 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9812 }
9813
9814 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9815
9816 \f
9817 /***********************************************************************
9818 Initialization
9819 ***********************************************************************/
9820
9821 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9822 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9823 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9824 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9825
9826 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9827 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9828 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9829
9830 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9831 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9832 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9833 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9834 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9835 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9836 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9837 };
9838
9839 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9840
9841 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9842
9843 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9844
9845 static int x_initialized;
9846
9847 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9848 the screen number from the server number. */
9849 static int
9850 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9851 {
9852 int seen_colon = 0;
9853 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9854 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9855 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9856
9857 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9858 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9859 length_until_period++;
9860
9861 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9862 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9863 name1 += 4;
9864 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9865 name2 += 4;
9866 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9867 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9868 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9869 name1 += system_name_length;
9870 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9871 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9872 name2 += system_name_length;
9873 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9874 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9875 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9876 name1 += length_until_period;
9877 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9878 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9879 name2 += length_until_period;
9880
9881 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9882 {
9883 if (*name1 == ':')
9884 seen_colon = 1;
9885 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9886 return 1;
9887 }
9888 return (seen_colon
9889 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9890 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9891 }
9892
9893 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9894 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9895 to 5. */
9896 static void
9897 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9898 {
9899 int nr = 0;
9900 int off = 0;
9901
9902 while (!(mask & 1))
9903 {
9904 off++;
9905 mask >>= 1;
9906 }
9907
9908 while (mask & 1)
9909 {
9910 nr++;
9911 mask >>= 1;
9912 }
9913
9914 *offset = off;
9915 *bits = nr;
9916 }
9917
9918 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9919 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9920
9921 int
9922 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9923 {
9924 int dpy_ok = 1;
9925 Display *dpy;
9926
9927 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9928 if (dpy)
9929 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9930 else
9931 dpy_ok = 0;
9932 return dpy_ok;
9933 }
9934
9935 #ifdef USE_GTK
9936 static void
9937 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9938 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9939 {
9940 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9941 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9942 }
9943 #endif
9944
9945 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9946 the structure that describes the open display.
9947 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9948
9949 struct x_display_info *
9950 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9951 {
9952 int connection;
9953 Display *dpy;
9954 struct terminal *terminal;
9955 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9956 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9957 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9958 ptrdiff_t lim;
9959
9960 BLOCK_INPUT;
9961
9962 if (!x_initialized)
9963 {
9964 x_initialize ();
9965 ++x_initialized;
9966 }
9967
9968 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9969 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9970
9971 #ifdef USE_GTK
9972 {
9973 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9974 int argc;
9975 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9976 char **argv2 = argv;
9977 guint id;
9978
9979 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9980 {
9981 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9982 }
9983 else
9984 {
9985 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9986 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9987
9988 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9989 argv[argc] = 0;
9990
9991 argc = 0;
9992 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9993
9994 if (! NILP (display_name))
9995 {
9996 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9997 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9998 }
9999
10000 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
10001 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10002
10003 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10004
10005 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10006 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10007 {
10008 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
10009 putenv (fix_events);
10010 }
10011
10012 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10013 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10014 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10015 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10016
10017 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10018 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10019 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10020
10021 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10022 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10023
10024 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10025 fixup_locale ();
10026 xg_initialize ();
10027
10028 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10029
10030 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10031 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10032 {
10033 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10034 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10035
10036 s = build_string (file);
10037 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10038
10039 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10040 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10041 }
10042 #endif
10043
10044 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10045 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10046 }
10047 }
10048 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10049 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10050 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10051 errors with X11R5:
10052 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10053 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10054 So let's not use it until R6. */
10055 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10056 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10057 #endif
10058
10059 {
10060 int argc = 0;
10061 char *argv[3];
10062
10063 argv[0] = "";
10064 argc = 1;
10065 if (xrm_option)
10066 {
10067 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10068 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10069 }
10070 turn_on_atimers (0);
10071 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10072 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10073 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10074 &argc, argv);
10075 turn_on_atimers (1);
10076
10077 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10078 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10079 fixup_locale ();
10080 #endif
10081 }
10082
10083 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10084 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10085 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10086 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10087 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10088
10089 /* Detect failure. */
10090 if (dpy == 0)
10091 {
10092 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10093 return 0;
10094 }
10095
10096 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10097
10098 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10099 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10100
10101 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10102
10103 {
10104 struct x_display_info *share;
10105 Lisp_Object tail;
10106
10107 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10108 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10109 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10110 SSDATA (display_name)))
10111 break;
10112 if (share)
10113 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10114 else
10115 {
10116 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10117 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10118 KSET (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system, Qx);
10119
10120 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10121 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10122 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10123 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10124 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10125
10126 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10127 {
10128 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10129
10130 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10131 list of terminals. */
10132 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10133 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10134 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10135 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10136
10137 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10138 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10139 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10140 KSET (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist,
10141 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10142 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10143 BLOCK_INPUT;
10144 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10145 terminal_list = terminal;
10146 UNGCPRO;
10147 }
10148
10149 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10150 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10151 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10152 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10153 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10154 }
10155 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10156 }
10157
10158 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10159 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10160 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10161
10162 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10163 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10164 x_display_name_list);
10165 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10166
10167 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10168
10169 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10170 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10171 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10172 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10173
10174 #if 0
10175 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10176 #endif /* ! 0 */
10177
10178 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10179 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10180 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10181 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10182 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10183 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10184 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10185
10186 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10187 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10188
10189 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10190 #ifdef USE_GTK
10191 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10192 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10193 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10194
10195 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10196 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10197
10198 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10199 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10200 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10201 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10202 #else
10203 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10204 #endif
10205 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10206 all versions. */
10207 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10208
10209 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10210 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10211 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10212 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10213 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10214 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10215 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10216 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10217 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10218 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10219 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10220 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10221 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10222 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10223 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10224 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10225 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10226 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10227 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10228 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10229 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10230 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10231 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10232 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10233 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10235 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10236 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10237
10238 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10239 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10240 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10241
10242 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10243 {
10244 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10245 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10246 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10247 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10248 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10249 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10250 }
10251
10252 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10253 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10254 {
10255 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10256 {
10257 Lisp_Object value;
10258 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10259 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10260 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10261 Qnil, Qnil);
10262 if (STRINGP (value)
10263 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10264 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10265 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10266 }
10267 }
10268 else
10269 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10270 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10271
10272 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10273 {
10274 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10275 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10276 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10277 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10278 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10279 for example). */
10280 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10281 double d;
10282 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10283 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10284 }
10285 #endif
10286
10287 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10288 {
10289 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10290 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10291 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10292 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10293 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10294 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10295 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10296 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10297 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10298 }
10299
10300 {
10301 const struct
10302 {
10303 const char *name;
10304 Atom *atom;
10305 } atom_refs[] = {
10306 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10307 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10308 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10309 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10310 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10311 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10312 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10313 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10314 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10315 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10316 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10317 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10318 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10319 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10320 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10321 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10322 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10323 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10324 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10325 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10326 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10327 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10328 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10329 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10330 /* For properties of font. */
10331 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10332 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10333 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10334 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10335 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10336 /* Ghostscript support. */
10337 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10338 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10339 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10340 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10341 /* EWMH */
10342 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10343 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10344 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10345 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10346 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10347 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10348 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10349 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10350 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10351 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10352 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10353 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10354 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10355 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10356 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10357 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10358 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10359 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10360 /* Session management */
10361 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10362 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10363 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10364 };
10365
10366 int i;
10367 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10368 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10369 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10370 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10371 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10372 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10373 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10374 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10375
10376 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10377 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10378
10379 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10380 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10381 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10382 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10383
10384 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10385 False, atoms_return);
10386
10387 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10388 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10389
10390 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10391 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10392
10393 xfree (atom_names);
10394 xfree (atoms_return);
10395 }
10396
10397 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10398 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10399 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10400 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10401
10402 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10403 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10404 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10405
10406 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10407 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10408 dpyinfo->gray
10409 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10410 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10411 1, 0, 1);
10412
10413 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10414 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10415 #endif
10416
10417 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10418
10419 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10420 if (connection != 0)
10421 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10422
10423 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10424 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10425 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10426
10427 #ifdef SIGIO
10428 if (interrupt_input)
10429 init_sigio (connection);
10430 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10431
10432 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10433 {
10434 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10435 Font font;
10436
10437 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10438 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10439 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10440 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10441 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10442 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10443 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10444 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10445 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10446 abort ();
10447 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10448 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10449 x_uncatch_errors ();
10450 }
10451 #endif
10452
10453 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10454 for debugging X code. */
10455 {
10456 Lisp_Object value;
10457 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10458 build_string ("synchronous"),
10459 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10460 Qnil, Qnil);
10461 if (STRINGP (value)
10462 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10463 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10464 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10465 }
10466
10467 {
10468 Lisp_Object value;
10469 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10470 build_string ("useXIM"),
10471 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10472 Qnil, Qnil);
10473 #ifdef USE_XIM
10474 if (STRINGP (value)
10475 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10476 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10477 use_xim = 0;
10478 #else
10479 if (STRINGP (value)
10480 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10481 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10482 use_xim = 1;
10483 #endif
10484 }
10485
10486 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10487 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10488 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10489 tty. */
10490 if (terminal->id == 1)
10491 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10492 #endif
10493
10494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10495
10496 return dpyinfo;
10497 }
10498 \f
10499 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10500 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10501
10502 static void
10503 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10504 {
10505 struct terminal *t;
10506
10507 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10508 X display. */
10509 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10510 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10511 {
10512 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10513 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10514 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10515 x_session_close ();
10516 #endif
10517 delete_terminal (t);
10518 break;
10519 }
10520
10521 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10522
10523 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10524 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10525 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10526 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10527 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10528 else
10529 {
10530 Lisp_Object tail;
10531
10532 tail = x_display_name_list;
10533 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10534 {
10535 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10536 {
10537 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10538 break;
10539 }
10540 tail = XCDR (tail);
10541 }
10542 }
10543
10544 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10545 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10546
10547 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10548 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10549 else
10550 {
10551 struct x_display_info *tail;
10552
10553 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10554 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10555 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10556 }
10557
10558 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10559 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10560 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10561 xfree (dpyinfo);
10562 }
10563
10564 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10565
10566 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10567 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10568 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10569 that slows us down. */
10570
10571 static void
10572 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10573 {
10574 BLOCK_INPUT;
10575 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10576 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10577 {
10578 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10579 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10580 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10581 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10582 }
10583 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10584 }
10585
10586 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10587 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10588 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10589 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10590 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10591 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10592 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10593
10594 void
10595 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10596 {
10597 BLOCK_INPUT;
10598 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10599 {
10600 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10601 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10602 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10603 }
10604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10605 }
10606
10607 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10608
10609 \f
10610 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10611
10612 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10613
10614 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10615 {
10616 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10617 x_produce_glyphs,
10618 x_write_glyphs,
10619 x_insert_glyphs,
10620 x_clear_end_of_line,
10621 x_scroll_run,
10622 x_after_update_window_line,
10623 x_update_window_begin,
10624 x_update_window_end,
10625 x_cursor_to,
10626 x_flush,
10627 #ifdef XFlush
10628 x_flush,
10629 #else
10630 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10631 #endif
10632 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10633 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10634 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10635 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10636 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10637 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10638 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10639 x_draw_glyph_string,
10640 x_define_frame_cursor,
10641 x_clear_frame_area,
10642 x_draw_window_cursor,
10643 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10644 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10645 };
10646
10647
10648 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10649 void
10650 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10651 {
10652 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10653
10654 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10655 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10656 if (!terminal->name)
10657 return;
10658
10659 BLOCK_INPUT;
10660 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10661 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10662 X display. */
10663 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10664 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10665 #endif
10666
10667 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10668 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10669 if (dpyinfo->display)
10670 {
10671 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10672 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10673
10674 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10675 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10676 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10677 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10678
10679 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10680 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10681 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10682 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10683 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10684 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10685 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10686 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10687 leaks in other situations. */
10688 #if 0
10689 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10690 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10691 #else
10692 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10693 #endif
10694 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10695 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10696 closing all the displays. */
10697 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10698 #endif
10699
10700 #ifdef USE_GTK
10701 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10702 #else
10703 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10704 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10705 #else
10706 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10707 #endif
10708 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10709 }
10710
10711 /* Mark as dead. */
10712 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10713 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10714 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10715 }
10716
10717 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10718 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10719
10720 static struct terminal *
10721 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10722 {
10723 struct terminal *terminal;
10724
10725 terminal = create_terminal ();
10726
10727 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10728 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10729 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10730
10731 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10732
10733 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10734 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10735 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10736 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10737 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10738 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10739 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10740 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10741 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10742 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10743 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10744 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10745 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10746 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10747 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10748 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10749 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10750 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10751 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10752 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10753
10754 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10755 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10756
10757 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10758 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10759 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10760 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10761 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10762 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10763 off the bottom. */
10764
10765 return terminal;
10766 }
10767
10768 void
10769 x_initialize (void)
10770 {
10771 baud_rate = 19200;
10772
10773 x_noop_count = 0;
10774 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10775 any_help_event_p = 0;
10776 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10777
10778 #ifdef USE_GTK
10779 current_count = -1;
10780 #endif
10781
10782 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10783 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10784
10785 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10786 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10787
10788 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10789
10790 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10791 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10792 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10793 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10794 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10795 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10796 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10797
10798 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10799 #endif
10800
10801 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10802 #ifndef USE_GTK
10803 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10804 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10805 #endif
10806 #endif
10807
10808 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10809 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10810 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10811
10812 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10813 original error handler. */
10814 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10815 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10816
10817 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10818
10819 xgselect_initialize ();
10820 }
10821
10822
10823 void
10824 syms_of_xterm (void)
10825 {
10826 x_error_message = NULL;
10827
10828 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10829 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10830
10831 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10832 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10833
10834 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10835 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10836
10837 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10838 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10839
10840 #ifdef USE_GTK
10841 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10842 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10843
10844 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10845 #endif
10846
10847 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10848 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10849 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10850 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10851 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10852 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10853 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10854 sizes. */);
10855 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10856
10857 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10858 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10859 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10860 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10861 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10862 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10863 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10864
10865 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10866 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10867 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10868 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10869 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10870 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10871 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10872 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10873 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10874
10875 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10876 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10877 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10878 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10879 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10880 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10881 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10882 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10883 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10884 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10885 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10886 #elif USE_GTK
10887 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10888 #else
10889 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10890 #endif
10891 #else
10892 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10893 #endif
10894
10895 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10896 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10897
10898 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10899 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10900 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10901 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10902 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10903 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10904 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10905 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10906 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10907
10908 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10909 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10910 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10911 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10912 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10913 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10914
10915 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10916 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10917 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10918 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10919 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10920 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10921
10922 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10923 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10924 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10925 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10926 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10927 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10928
10929 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10930 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10931 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10932 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10933 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10934 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10935
10936 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10937 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10938 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10939 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10940 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10941 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10942 }
10943
10944 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */